2003 Pilot Online Reference Owner's Manual...
Transcript of 2003 Pilot Online Reference Owner's Manual...
Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com.
Contents
Owner's Identification Form Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................. ii
Important Handling Information .....................................................................................................iii
Your Vehicle at a Glance .....................................................................................................................2 Driver and Passenger Safety ..............................................................................................................5 Proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System.
Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 117 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features.
What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo.
The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer.
The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer. Appearance Care.............................................................................................................................. 267 Tips on cleaning and protecting your vehicle. Things to look for if your vehicle ever needs body repairs.
This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them.
ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information.
A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us.
How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I
Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 215
Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 229
Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 269
Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 325
Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 373
Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 377
Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 359
2003 Pilot Online Reference Owner's Manual
Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 5 9
Information Provided by:
This Owner’s Manual should be considereda permanent part of the vehicle, and shouldremain with the vehicle when it is sold.
The information and specifications includedin this publication were in effect at the timeof approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specifications ordesign at any time without notice andwithout incurring any obligation whatsoever.
This Owner’s Manual covers all models ofthe Pilot. You may find descriptions ofequipment and features that are not on yourparticular model.
Owner’s Identif ication
POUR CLIENTS CANADIENAVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avezbesoin d’un Manuel du Conducteuren français, veuillez demander àvotre concessionnaire decommander le numéro de pièce33S9VC00
OWNER
ADDRESS
V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE
DEALER NAME DEALER NO.
ADDRESS
OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
Information Provided by:
California Proposition 65 Warning
This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State ofCalifornia to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.
Congratulations! Your selection of a 2003 Honda Pilot was a wise investment.It will give you years of driving pleasure.
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new Honda is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle soyou can refer to it at any time.
Several warranties protect your new Honda. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the schedules given in this manualhelps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves your investment.When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind that your Hondadealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems unique toyour Honda. Your Honda dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will bepleased to answer any questions and concerns.
As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your Honda, otherproperty, or the environment.
Introduction
WARNING:
i
Information Provided by:
--
--
-
-
Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thisvehicle safely is an importantresponsibility.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:
on the vehicle.
To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your vehicle. You mustuse your own good judgement.
These signal words mean:
preceded by a safety alert symbol and one ofthree signal words: , , or .
such as Driver and Passenger Safety.how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.
This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.
A Few Words About Safety
Safety LabelsSafety Messages
Safety SectionInstructions
Safety Headings
DANGER WARNING CAUTION
ii
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.
Information Provided by:
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher off the ground, it has a highcenter of gravity. This means your vehicle can tip or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have asignificantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantlymore likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder, make sure you and your passengers always wearseat belts.
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover, read ‘‘Driving Guidelines’’ on page of this manual and thesection on page . Failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an
accident.
Your Pilot has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use only on pavement. Higher groundclearance has many advantages for off-highway driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and roughterrain. It also provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
230261Off-Highway Guidelines
Important Handling Information
iii
Information Provided by:
Your Vehicle at a Glance
2
INDICATOR LIGHTSGAUGES
POWER DOOR LOCKSWITCHES
MIRRORCONTROLS
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
HOOD RELEASEHANDLE
AUDIO SYSTEM
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
(P.61)(P.67)
(P.82)
(P.103)
(P.99)
(P.218)
(P.110)
(P.118, 128)
(P.137, 153, 168)
FUEL FILL DOORRELEASE(P.217)
PARKING BRAKEPEDAL(P.104)
REAR A/C CONTROL(P.135)
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
Information Provided by:
*
*
To use the horn, press the pad around the ‘‘H’’ logo.:
Your Vehicle at a Glance
3
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNALS
LIGHT CONTROLSWITCH
CRUISECONTROL
REMOTE AUDIOCONTROLS
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
CRUISE CONTROL WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS
(P.112)
(P.72/74)
(P.207)
(P.188) (P.78) (P.74/76)
HORN HAZARD WARNINGLIGHTS
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER(P.77)
(P.238)
(P.77)
(P.207)
VTM-4 LOCK
Information Provided by:
4
Information Provided by:
This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat beltsproperly. It explains your Supple-mental Restraint System. And it tellsyou how to properly restrain infantsand children in your vehicle.
.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.......Your Vehicle’s Safety Features . 7
.......................................Seat Belts . 8...........................................Airbags . 9
.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 10..........................Head Restraints . 10
..................................Door Locks . 10........Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 11
............................Protecting Adults . 12
.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 12...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 12............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 13
...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 145. Fasten and Position the Seat
.....................................Belts . 15....6. Adjust the Steering Wheel . 18
7. Maintain a Proper Sitting................................Position . 18
.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19...Additional Safety Precautions . 19
........................Protecting Children . 21All Children Must Be
...............................Restrained . 21Children Should Sit in the Back
...........................................Seat . 22The Passenger’s Airbag Poses
......Serious Risks to Children . 23If You Must Drive with Several
...................................Children . 25If a Child Requires Close
..................................Attention . 25...Additional Safety Precautions . 25
General Guidelines for Using...............................Child Seats . 26
.......................Protecting Infants . 30
.........Protecting Small Children . 35.......Protecting Larger Children . 38
Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 42
.............................Using LATCH . 44Additional Information About Your
.................................Seat Belts . 46..Seat Belt System Components . 46
......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 46Automatic Seat Belt
...............................Tensioners . 48...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 49
Additional Information About Your.....................................Airbags . 50
........................SRS Components . 50How Your Front Airbags
.........................................Work . 50...How Your Side Airbags Work . 52
How the SRS Indicator Light.......................................Works . 53
How The Side Airbag Cutoff...........Indicator Light Works . 54
.............................Airbag Service . 55...Additional Safety Precautions . 55
.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56...................................Safety Labels . 57
Driver and Passenger Safety
Driver and Passenger Safety 5
Information Provided by:
You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.
Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed the greater therisk, but serious accidents can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.
While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual. (See page
.)
Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance. (See page .)
Children are safest when they areproperly restrained in a back seat,not the front seat. A child who is toosmall for a seat belt must be properlyrestrained in a child safety seat. (Seepage .)
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.
A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbagssupplement seat belts, but airbagsare designed to inflate only in amoderate to severe frontal collision.So even though your vehicle isequipped with airbags, make sureyou and your passengers alwayswear your seat belts, and wear themproperly. (See page .)15
9
21
272
Driver and Passenger Safety
Important Safety Precautions
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
Be Aware of Airbag Hazards Control Your Speed
Keep Your Vehicle in SafeCondition
Restrain All Children
Don’t Drink and Drive
6
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.
These safety features are designedto reduce the severity of injuries in acrash. However, you and yourpassengers can’t take full advantageof these safety features unless youremain sitting in a proper positionand
In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.
Some safety features do not requireany action on your part. Theseinclude a strong steel frameworkthat forms a safety cage around thepassenger compartment; front andrear crush zones that are designed tocrumple and absorb energy during acrash; a collapsible steering column;and seat belt tensioners thatautomatically tighten the front seatbelts in the event of a crash.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
always wear your seat beltsproperly.
7
(7)(10)
(9) (3) (1) (4)
(2)(6)(10)
(7) (8)(5)
(2)
(1) Safety Cage(2) Crush Zones(3) Seats & Seat-Backs(4) Head Restraints(5) Collapsible Steering Column(6) Seat Belts(7) Airbags(8) Front Seat Belt Tensioners(9) Door Locks(10) Side Airbags
Information Provided by:
Your seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the
instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your seatbelts.
Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
For your safety, and the safety ofyour passengers, your vehicle isequipped with seat belts in all seatingpositions.
In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces require you towear seat belts.
Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including frontal,side, and rear impacts androllovers.
Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.
When properly worn, seat belts:
Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.
Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.
Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag, andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.
Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.
Always wearyour seat belt, and make sure youwear it properly.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Seat Belts
Why Wear Seat Belts
What you should do:
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
8
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, evenif you have airbags.
Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.
Information Provided by:
They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.
To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force andspeed. So while airbags help savelives, they can cause minor injuries,or more serious or even fatalinjuries if occupants are notproperly restrained or sittingproperly.
Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard.
Your vehicle also has side airbags tohelp protect the upper torso of thedriver or a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe sideimpact.
The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:
Your car has a SupplementalRestraint System (SRS) with dual-stage, dual-threshold front airbags tohelp protect the heads and chests ofthe driver and a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe frontalcollision.
Airbags
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags do not replace seat belts.
Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, rollovers, or minorfrontal or side collisions.
Airbags can pose serious hazards.
What you should do:
9
Information Provided by:
Head restraints can help protect youfrom whiplash and other injuries. Formaximum protection, the back ofyour head should rest against thecenter of the head restraint.
Reclining a seat-back too far reducesthe seat belt’s effectiveness andincreases the chance that the seat’soccupant will slide under the seatbelt in a crash and be seriouslyinjured.
Move the frontseats as far back as possible, andkeep adjustable seat-backs in anupright position whenever thevehicle is moving.
Your vehicle’s seats are designed tokeep you in a comfortable, uprightposition so you can take fulladvantage of the protection offeredby seat belts and the energyabsorbing materials in the seats.
How you adjust your seats and seat-backs can also affect your safety. Forexample, sitting too close to thesteering wheel or dashboardincreases the risk of you or yourpassenger being injured by strikingthe inside of the vehicle, or by aninflating airbag.
Keeping your doors locked reducesthe chance of being thrown out ofthe vehicle during a crash. It alsohelps prevent occupants fromaccidentally opening a door andfalling out, and outsiders fromunexpectedly opening your doors.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Seats & Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Door Locks
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
What you should do:
10
Information Provided by:
To make sure you and yourpassengers get the maximumprotection from your vehicle’s safetyfeatures, check the following eachtime before you drive away:
All adults, and children who haveoutgrown child safety seats, arewearing their seat belts andwearing them properly (see page
).
Any infant or small child isproperly restrained in a child seatin a back seat (see page ).
Front seat occupants are sittingupright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel anddashboard (see page ).
Seat-backs are upright (see page).
Head restraints are properlyadjusted (see page ).
All doors and the tailgate areclosed and locked (see page ).
The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.
Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in severecrashes, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.
All cargo is properly stored orsecured (see page ).
15
22
12
13
14
12
225
Driver and Passenger Safety
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Pre-Drive Safety Checklist
11
Information Provided by:
The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver and other adultoccupants.
These instructions also apply tochildren who have outgrown childseats and are large enough to wearlap/shoulder belts. (See page forimportant additional guidelines onhow to properly protect largerchildren.)
Your vehicle has a door and tailgatemonitor light on the instrumentpanel to indicate when a specificdoor or the tailgate is not tightlyclosed.
For security, locked doors canprevent an outsider fromunexpectedly opening a door whenyou come to a stop.
See page for how to lock thedoors.
For safety, locking the doors reducesthe chance that a passenger,especially a child, will open a doorwhile the vehicle is moving andaccidentally fall out. It also reducesthe chance of someone being thrownout of the vehicle during a crash.
After everyone has entered thevehicle, be sure the doors andtailgate are closed and locked.
Any driver who sits too close to thesteering wheel is at risk of beingseriously injured or killed by strikingthe steering wheel or from beingstruck by an inflating front airbagduring a crash.
38
82
Driver and Passenger Safety
Protecting Adults
Introduction Adjust the Front Seats
Close and Lock the Doors1.
2.
12
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
To reduce the chance of injury, wearyour seat belt properly, sit uprightwith your back against the seat, andmove the seat away from thesteering wheel to the farthestdistance that allows you to maintainfull control of the vehicle. Also makesure your front seat passengermoves the seat as far to the rear aspossible.
See page for how to adjust thefront seats.
Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make surethe seat is locked in position.
Most shorter drivers can get farenough away from the steeringwheel and still reach the pedals.However, if you are concerned aboutsitting too close, we recommend thatyou investigate whether some typeof adaptive equipment may help.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversadjust the seat so the center of thechest is at least 10 inches (25 cm)away from the center of the steeringwheel. Also make sure your frontseat passenger moves the seat as farto the rear as possible.
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel. If yousit too close to the steering wheel,you could be injured if the frontairbag inflates.
89
Driver and Passenger Safety
Protecting Adults
Adjust the Seat-Backs3.
13
Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.
Information Provided by:
Before driving, make sure everyonewith an adjustable head restraint hasproperly positioned the headrestraint. The restraint should bepositioned so the back of theoccupant’s head rests against thecenter of the restraint. A tallerperson should adjust the restraint ashigh as possible.
See page for how to adjust seat-backs.
A front passenger should also adjustthe seat-back to an upright position,but as far from the dashboard aspossible. A passenger who sits tooclose to the dashboard could beinjured if the airbag inflates.
Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.
90
Driver and Passenger Safety
Protecting Adults
Adjust the Head Restraints4.
14
Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to anupright position and sit wellback in the seat.
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.
Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.
See page for how to adjust thehead restraints.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Also checkthat the belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.
In the second row center seat andthe third row seats, be sure thedetachable anchors are also latched(see page ).
Check that the seat belt is nottwisted, because a twisted belt cancause serious injuries in a crash.
97
93
Driver and Passenger Safety
Protecting Adults
Fasten and Position the SeatBelts
5.
15
Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.
Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.
Information Provided by:
If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.
If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack from theshoulder part, then check that thebelt rests across the center of yourchest and over your shoulder. Thisspreads the forces of a crash overthe strongest bones in your upperbody.
To adjust the height of a front seatbelt anchor, squeeze the two releasebuttons and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).
Driver and Passenger Safety
Protecting Adults
16
RELEASEBUTTON
Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.
Information Provided by:
This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.
See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsystem and how to take care of yourbelts.
If a seat belt does not seem to workas it should, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.
Anyone using a seat belt that isnot working properly can beseriously injured or killed. Have yourHonda dealer check the belt as soonas possible.
46
Protecting Adults
Driver and Passenger Safety
Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.
No one shouldsit in a seat with an inoperative seatbelt.
17
Information Provided by:
Adjust the steering wheel, if needed,so that the wheel points toward yourchest, not toward your face.
Pointing the steering wheel towardyour chest provides optimalprotection from the airbag.
See page for how to adjust thesteering wheel.
Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.
After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and put on seat belts, it isvery important that they continue tosit upright, well back in their seats,with their feet on the floor, until thevehicle is parked and the engine isoff.
In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured bystriking interior parts of the vehicle,or by being struck by an inflatingfront airbag. Being struck by aninflating side airbag can result inpossibly serious injuries.
Remember, to get the bestprotection from your vehicle’sairbags and other safety features,you must sit properly and wear yourseat belt properly.
78
Adjust the Steering Wheel Maintain a Proper SittingPosition
6. 7.
Protecting Adults
Driver and Passenger Safety18
Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.
Information Provided by:
Pregnant women should also situpright and as far back as possiblefrom the steering wheel ordashboard. This will reduce the riskof injuries to both the mother andher unborn child that can be causedby a crash or an inflating airbag.
Each time you have a check-up, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.
Because protecting the mother is thebest way to protect her unborn child,a pregnant woman should alwayswear a seat belt whenever she drivesor rides in a vehicle.
Remember to keep the lap portion ofthe belt as low as possible acrossyour hips.
All passengersmust sit in locked, upright seatsand be properly restrained by seatbelts.
A passenger who is notwearing a seat belt during a crashor emergency stop can be thrownagainst the inside of the vehicle,against other occupants, or out ofthe vehicle.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
CONTINUED
Advice for Pregnant Women Additional Safety PrecautionsNever let passengers ride in thecargo area or on top of a folded-down back seat.
Passengers should not stand up orchange seats while the vehicle ismoving.
Two people should never use thesame seat belt.
Protecting Adults
Driver and Passenger Safety 19
Information Provided by:
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canseverely compromise theprotective capability of the seatbelt and increase the chance ofserious injury in a crash.
Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.
If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thecar and hurt someone.
If yourhands or arms are close to theairbag covers in the center of thesteering wheel and on top of thedashboard, they could be injured ifthe airbags inflate.
Any objectattached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the car and hurtsomeone.
Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.
Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.
Do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.
Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.
Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.
Protecting Adults
Driver and Passenger Safety20
Information Provided by:
Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many parents and otheradults may not know how toprotect young passengers. (See page
.)So if you have children, or if you everneed to drive with a grandchild orother children in your vehicle, besure to read this section.
To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state andCanadian province requires thatinfants and children be restrainedwhenever they ride in a vehicle.
Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof death of children ages 12 andunder.
(See page .)
26
38
properly
All Children Must Be Restrained
Any child who is too small to wear aseat belt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat.
A larger child should always berestrained with a seat belt, and use abooster, if needed.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 21
Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.
Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt.
Information Provided by:
According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in theback seat, not the front seat. TheNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.
In a back seat, children are lesslikely to be injured by striking hardinterior parts during a collision orhard braking. Also, children cannotbe injured by an inflating airbagwhen they ride in the back.During a
crash, the belt could press deepinto the child and cause veryserious injuries.
If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crash, you could bethrown forward into thedashboard and crush the child.
If you are wearing a seat belt, thechild can be torn from your armsduring a crash. For example, ifyour vehicle crashes into a parkedvehicle at 30 mph (48 km/h), a20-lb (9 kg) infant will become a600-lb (275 kg) force, and you willnot be able to hold on.
Children Should Sit in the BackSeat
Never put a seat belt over yourselfand an infant or child.
Additional Precautions to ParentsNever hold an infant or child onyour lap.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety22
Information Provided by:
Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it inflates with tremendousspeed.
Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.
Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, in a booster seat if needed, andbe properly restrained with a seatbelt. (See page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren.)
38
The Passenger’s Front AirbagPoses Serious Risks to Children
Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.
Infants
Small ChildrenPlacing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Larger ChildrenChildren who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 23
Information Provided by:
To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin a back seat, your vehicle haswarning labels on the dashboard andon the driver’s and front passenger’svisors. Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.
To remind you of the front airbaghazards, your vehicle has warninglabels on the driver’s and frontpassenger’s visors. Please read andfollow the instructions on theselabels.
U.S. Models Canadian Models
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety24
Information Provided by:
Using this feature willprevent children from opening thedoors and accidentally falling out(see page ).
Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.
Your vehicle has two rows of backseats where children can be properlyrestrained.
Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear a seat beltproperly (see page ).
Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).
Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).
Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page
).
If you ever have to carry a group ofchildren (when carpooling forexample), and a child must ride infront:
Usingthis feature will prevent childrenfrom playing with the windows,which could expose them tohazards or distract the driver (seepage ).
Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards fromthe passenger’s front airbag, andpaying close attention to a childdistracts the driver from theimportant tasks of driving, placingboth of you at risk.
If a child requires physical attentionor frequent visual contact, westrongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in a backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.
Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignition,and open the tailgate, which canlead to accidental injury or death.
12
15
38
18
87
99
CONTINUED
Additional Safety PrecautionsIf a Child Requires CloseAttention
If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren Use childproof door locks to
prevent children from opening thedoors.
Use the main power windowswitch to prevent children fromopening the rear windows.
Keep vehicle keys and remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 25
Information Provided by:
Children up to about oneyear old should be restrained in arear-facing, reclining child seat. Onlya rear-facing seat provides theproper support to protect an infant’shead, neck, and back. See page
for additional information onprotecting infants.
The following pages give generalguidelines for selecting and installingchild seats for infants and smallchildren.
To provide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:
Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates and Canadian provinces,and can be very hazardous. Forexample, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Andchildren left alone with the key inthe ignition can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.
The child seat shouldmeet Federal Motor VehicleSafety Standard 213 (FMVSS 213)or Canadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213 (CMVSS 213). Lookfor the manufacturer’s statementof compliance on the box. 30
Infants:
Selecting a Child Seat
The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.
Do not leave children alone in yourvehicle.
The child seat should meet safetystandards.
1.
2.
General Guidelines for UsingChild Seats
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety26
Information Provided by:
A child who is toolarge for a rear-facing child seat, andwho can sit up without support,should be restrained in a forward-facing child seat. See page foradditional information on protectingsmall children.
Due to variations in the design ofchild seats, vehicle seats, and seatbelts, all child seats will not fit allvehicle seating positions.
Before purchasing a child seat, werecommend that parents test thechild seat in the specific vehicleseating position (or positions) wherethey intend to use the seat. If apreviously purchased child seat doesnot fit, you may need to buy adifferent one that will fit.
However, Honda is confident thatone or more child seat models can fitand be properly installed in allrecommended seating positions inyour vehicle.
35
Small Children:
The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.
3.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 27
Information Provided by:
A small child in a forward-facingchild seat is also at risk. If thevehicle seat is too far forward,or the child’s head is thrownforward during a collision, aninflating airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.
If a small child must ride in thefront, follow the instructionsprovided in this section.
The passenger’s front airbaginflates with enough force to killor seriously injure an infant in arear-facing child seat.
Recommended positions.Properly secure a rear-facing childseat (see page ).
Recommendedpositions. Properly secure a front-facing child seat (see page ).
Never in the front seat, dueto the front airbag hazard.
Not recommended,due to the front airbag hazard. If asmall child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position and secure a front-facing child seat with the seat belt(see page ).
This page briefly summarizesHonda’s recommendations on whereto place rear-facing and forward-facing child seats in your vehicle.
36
31
36
Placing a Child Seat Front Passenger’s Seat
Back SeatsInfants:
Small children:
Infants:
Small children:
Airbags Pose SeriousRisks to Children
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety28
Information Provided by:
After selecting a proper child seat,and a good position to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:
Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be thrown out of the seat in acrash and be seriously injured.
However, a child seat does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ In some vehiclesor seating positions, it may bedifficult to install a child seat so thatit does not move at all. Some side-to-side or back-and-forth movement canbe expected and should not reducethe child seat’s effectiveness.
When you are not using a child seat,either remove it and store it in a safeplace, or make sure it is properlysecured. An unsecured child seat canbe thrown around the vehicle duringa crash or sudden stop and injuresomeone.
If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly securedin the desired seating position.
To provide security during normaldriving maneuvers as well as duringa collision, we recommend thatparents secure a child seat as firmlyas possible.
All child seats aredesigned to be secured to thevehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. Some child seatscan be secured to the vehicle’sLATCH anchorage system instead.A child whose seat is not properlysecured to the vehicle can beendangered in a crash. See pages
, and for instructions onhow to properly secure child seatsin this vehicle.
After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure.
31 4436
Installing a Child Seat Secure the child in the child seat.
Storing a Child Seat
Properly secure the child seat tothe vehicle.
Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.
1.
2.
3.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 29
Information Provided by:
Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back. Infants up to aboutone year of age must be restrained ina rear-facing child seat.
We recommend that an infant berestrained in a rear-facing child seatuntil the infant reaches the seatmaker’s weight or height limit and isable to sit up without support.
Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.
In this vehicle, a rear-facing childseat can be placed in any seatingposition in a back seat, but not in thefront seat.
If the passenger’sfront airbag inflates, it can hit theback of the child seat with enoughforce to kill or seriously injure aninfant. If an infant must be closelywatched, we recommend thatanother adult sit in the back seatwith the baby.
If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.
Protecting Infants
Child Seat Type
Rear-Facing Child Seat Placement
Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat.
Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety30
Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.
Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.
Information Provided by:
The following pages provideinstructions on how to secure a rear-facing child seat with this type ofseat belt.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).
With the child seat in the desiredback seating position, route thebelt through the child seataccording to the seat maker’sinstructions, then insert the latchplate into the buckle.
The lap/shoulder belts in the backseats have a locking mechanism thatmust be activated to secure a childseat.
If you have a child seat designedto attach to the vehicle’s LATCHanchorage system, follow theinstructions on page .
Before installing a child seat in thecenter seat of the second row orone of the third row seats, makesure the seat belt detachableanchor is latched (see page ).
1.
2. 3.
44
97
CONTINUED
Installing a Rear-Facing Child Seatwith a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 31
Information Provided by:
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat, whilepulling up on the belt.
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.
4.
5. 6.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety32
Information Provided by:
To deactivate the lockingmechanism and remove a child seat,unlatch the buckle, unroute the seatbelt, and let the belt fully retract.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 33
Information Provided by:
For proper protection, an infant mustride in a reclined, or semi-reclinedposition. To determine the properreclining angle, check with the baby’sdoctor or follow the seat maker’srecommendations.
To achieve the desired recliningangle, it may help to put a rolled uptowel under the toe of the child seat,as shown.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front-seat passenger frommoving the seat as far back asrecommended (see page ). Or itmay prevent them from locking theseat-back in the desired uprightposition (see page ).
In either case, we recommend thatyou place the child seat in anotherback seating position, or leave theaffected seat unoccupied. If theproblem cannot be solved, you maywish to get a smaller rear-facingchild seat.
12
13
Rear-Facing Child Seat InstallationTips
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety34
Information Provided by:
In this vehicle, the best place toinstall a forward-facing child seat isin one of the seating positions in aback seat.We also recommend that a small
child stay in the child seat as long aspossible, until the child reaches theweight or height limit for the seat.
Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to causevery serious or fatal injuries. If asmall child must be closely watched,we recommend that another adult sitin the back seat with the child.
A child at least one year old who cansit up without support, and who fitswithin the child seat maker’s weightand height limits, should berestrained in a forward-facing,upright child seat.
CONTINUED
Protecting Small Children
Child Seat Type
Child Seat Placement
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 35
Information Provided by:
The lap/shoulder belts in the outerback and front passenger seatingpositions have a locking mechanismthat must be activated to secure achild seat.
The following pages provideinstructions on how to secure aforward-facing child seat with thistype of seat belt.
With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle.
If you have a child seat designedto attach to the vehicle’sLATCH anchorage system,follow the instructions on page
.
If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the vehicle, and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.
Before installing a child seat in thecenter seat of the second row orone of the third row seats, makesure the seat belt detachableanchor is latched (see page ).
1.
2.
44
97
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety36
Improperly placing a forward-facing child seat in the frontseat can result in serious injuryor death if the front airbagsinflate.
If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible and properly restrainthe child.
Information Provided by:
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure. Itmay help to put weight on thechild seat, or push on the back ofthe seat, while pulling up on thebelt.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor (you might hear aclicking noise as the belt retracts).
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked andyou will need to repeat these steps.
3.
4.
5. 6.
CONTINUED
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 37
Information Provided by:
To deactivate the lockingmechanism in order to remove achild restraint system, unlatch thebuckle, unroute the seat belt, and letthe belt fully retract.
When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in the back seat on abooster and wear a lap/shoulder belt.
We recommend that the child use abooster seat until the child is tallenough to use the seat belt without abooster.
The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in the front seat.
Protecting Larger Children
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety38
Allowing a larger child to sitimproperly in the front seat canresult in injury or death if thepassenger’s front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must sit in front,make sure the child moves theseat as far back as possible,uses a booster seat if needed,and wears the seat belt properly.
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
To determine if a lap/shoulder beltproperly fits a child, have the childsit in the rear seat, all the way backagainst the seat, and put on the seatbelt. Follow the instructions on page
. Then check how the belt fits.
If the shoulder part of the belt restsover the child’s collarbone andagainst the center of the chest, andthe lap belt rests over the child’shipbones and touches the tops of the
thighs as shown, the child isprobably big enough to wear the seatbelt.
However, if the shoulder belttouches or crosses the child’s neck,or if the lap belt crosses the child’sstomach, the child needs to use abooster seat.
This could result in serious neck andinternal injuries during a crash.
This could causevery serious injuries during a crash.It also increases the chance that thechild will slide under the belt in acrash and be injured.
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt, severelycompromise the protective capabilityof the seat belt and increase thechance of serious injury in a crash.
If they do, they couldbe very seriously injured in a crash.
15
Checking Seat Belt Fit
Do not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck or over the stomach.
Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the back orunder the arm.
Do not put any accessories on a seatbelt.
Two children should never use thesame seat belt.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 39
Information Provided by:
Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in thefront, there are other importantfactors you should consider.
Whichever style you select, followthe booster seat maker’s instructions.
The back seat is the safest place fora child of any age or size.
In addition, the passenger’s frontairbag poses serious risks to children.If the seat is too far forward, or thechild’s head is thrown forwardduring a collision, or the child isunrestrained or out of position, aninflating front airbag can kill orseriously injure the child.
The side airbag also poses risks. Ifany part of a larger child’s body is inthe path of a deploying airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.
If a child needs a booster seat, werecommend choosing a high or low-back style that allows the child to bedirectly secured with the lap/shoulder belt.
A child should continue using abooster seat until the child exceedsthe booster seat manufacturer’srequirements.
Even then, the child may still need touse a booster seat. Note that somestates now require children to useboosters until they reach a certainage and/or weight. Be sure to checkcurrent laws in the state or stateswhere you intend to drive.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenages 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.
Using a Booster Seat
When Can a Larger Child Sit in Front
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety40
Information Provided by:
If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manualand make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.
Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.
Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.
Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly positioned and secured.
Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit over the hips, chest, andshoulder (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,the child should not sit in the front.
To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.
Supervise the child. Even maturechildren sometimes need to bereminded to fasten the seat beltsor sit properly.
Remind the child not to leantoward the door because of theside airbag.
15 39
Physical Size
Maturity
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 41
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle has attachment pointsfor a tether-style child seat to beinstalled on the second or third rowas shown.
Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.
Each second row seat has a tetheranchorage point behind the seatback.
There are three anchorage points onthe tailgate sill. Select the anchoragepoint you want to use, and slide thecover to open it (outboard anchor),or remove the cover (center anchor).
Second Seat Installation: Third Seat Installation:Using Child Seats with Tethers
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety42
TETHER ANCHORAGE POINT
Information Provided by:
Lift the head restraint, then routethe tether strap over the seat-backbetween the legs of the headrestraint.
Attach the tether strap hook to thetether attachment point, and tightenthe strap according to the child seatmaker’s instructions. Make sure thestrap is not twisted.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety 43
Information Provided by:
Put the child seat in a second rowvehicle seat and attach the childseat to the lower anchorsaccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions.
Your vehicle is equipped withLATCH (Lower Anchors andTethers for Children) at the secondrow seats. The lower anchors arelocated between the seat-back andseat bottom and are to be used onlywith a child seat designed for usewith LATCH.
The exact location of each loweranchorage is marked with a smallcircle above the lower anchoragepoint.
Move the seat belt buckle or seatbelt tongue away from the loweranchors.
To install a LATCH-compatible childseat:
Make sure there are no foreignobjects around the anchors.Foreign objects could get in theway of a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.
1.
2.
3.
Using LATCH
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety44
LOWERANCHORS RIGID TYPE
MARKS
Information Provided by:
Follow the child seat maker’sinstructions for any additionaladvice on adjusting or tighteningthe fit.
Attach the attaching clip to thetether anchor fitting and tightenthe strap according to the childseat maker’s instructions. Makesure the strap is not twisted.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side to side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers.
This symbol on rear or forwardfacing child seats or boostercushions indicates the presence ofLATCH compatible hardware.
4. 5.
6.
Protecting Children
Driver and Passenger Safety
Lower Universal AnchorageSystem Symbol
45
FLEXIBLE TYPE
Information Provided by:
The seat belt system alsoincludes a light on the
instrument panel to remind you andyour passengers to fasten your belts.If the driver’s seat belt is notfastened before the ignition is turnedON (II), the light will come on and abeeper will also sound. The beeperwill stop after a few seconds, but thelight will stay on until the driver’sseat belt is fastened.
The lap/shoulder belts goes overyour shoulder, across your chest,and across your hips.
Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all eight seatingpositions. The front seat belts arealso equipped with automatic seatbelt tensioners.
The lap/shoulder belts in the centerseat of the second row and third rowseats are equipped with a detachableanchor that has two parts: a smalllatch plate and a buckle.
The detachable anchor shouldnormally be latched whenever theseats-backs are in an upright position.For more information about thedetachable anchors, see page .97
Seat Belt System Components Lap/Shoulder Belt
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver and Passenger Safety46
Information Provided by:
The seat belts in all seating positionsexcept the driver’s have an additionallocking mechanism that must beactivated to secure a child seat. (Seepages and for instructions onhow to secure child seats with thistype of seat belt.)
If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockingmechanism will activate. The beltwill retract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.
To deactivate the lockingmechanism, unlatch the buckle andlet the seat belt fully retract. Torefasten the belt, pull it out only asfar as needed.
See page for instructions on howto wear the lap/shoulder beltproperly.
To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched.
To unlock the belt, push the redPRESS button on the buckle.Guide the belt across your body sothat it retracts completely. Afterexiting the vehicle, be sure the beltis out of the way and will not getclosed in the door.
All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body. 15
31 36
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver and Passenger Safety 47
Information Provided by:
If your airbags inflate, the tensionersimmediately tighten the front seatbelts to help hold the occupants inplace. The belts will remain tightuntil you unbuckle them in thenormal way.
The SRS indicator light willcome on if there is a
problem with your automatic seatbelt tensioners (see page ).
Your vehicle has automatic seat belttensioners for added protectionduring a moderate to severe frontalcollision.
53
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
Driver and Passenger Safety
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
48
Information Provided by:
For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.
Pull each belt out fully and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthat the lap/shoulder belts retracteasily. Any belt not in good conditionor not working properly will notprovide good protection and shouldbe replaced as soon as possible.
For information on how to clean yourseat belts, see page .
Automatic seat belt tensioners thatdeployed during a crash must bereplaced.
If a seat belt is worn during a crash,it must be replaced by the dealer. Abelt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed.
Honda provides a lifetime warrantyon seat belts. Honda will repair orreplace any seat belt component thatfails to function properly duringnormal use. Please see your
booklet fordetails.
329
HondaWarranty Information
Seat Belt Maintenance
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver and Passenger Safety
U.S. Models
49
Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.
Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.
Information Provided by:
Your Supplemental Restraint System(SRS) includes:
Two front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG.’’
Automatic seat belt tensionersthat tighten the front seat belts inthe event of a moderate to severefrontal collision (see page ).
Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe frontalcollision.
A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, and driver andpassenger seat belt use when the
ignition is ON (II).
An indicator light on theinstrument panel that alerts you toa possible problem with thesystem (see page ).
Emergency backup power in caseyour vehicle’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, the sensorswill detect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration. If the rate ofdeceleration is high enough, thecontrol unit will instantly inflate thefront airbags.
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-stage, dual-threshold airbags to helpreduce the chance of airbag-causedinjuries.
48
53
SRS Components How Your Front Airbags Work
Driver and Passenger Safety
Additional Information About Your Airbags
50
Information Provided by:
After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe vehicle as soon as it is safe to doso.
For additional information on howyour airbags work, see the booklettitled
that came with yourowner’s manual.
The total time for inflation anddeflation is approximately one-tenthof a second, so fast that mostoccupants are not aware that theairbags deployed until they see themlying in their laps.
For additional information on howyour airbags work, ask your dealerfor a copy of the booklet titled
During a frontal crash, your seatbelts help restrain your lower bodyand torso. Your airbag provides acushion to help restrain and protectyour head and chest.
Since both airbags use the samesensors, both airbags normallyinflate at the same time. However, itis possible for only one airbag toinflate.
This can occur when the severity ofa collision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.
After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.
SRS: What You Need to KnowAbout Airbags
SRS:What You Need to Know About Airbags.
Driver and Passenger Safety
Additional Information About Your Airbags
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
51
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle is equipped with sideairbags for the driver and a frontseat passenger. The airbags arestored in the outer edges of the frontseat-backs, and both are marked‘‘SIDE AIRBAG.’’
If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, the sensors willdetect rapid deceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag.
Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.
To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver and Passenger Safety
How Your Side Airbags Work
52
Information Provided by:
If the light comes on at any othertime, or does not come on at all, youshould have the system checked byyour dealer. For example:
If the SRS indicator light does notcome on after you turn the ignitionON (II).
If the light stays on after theengine starts.
If the light comes on or flashes onand off while you drive.
The SRS indicator lightalerts you to a potential
problem with your front airbags andautomatic seat belt tensioners.
When you turn the ignition ON (II),this indicator will light briefly thengo out. This tells you that the systemis working properly.
This light will also alert you to apotential problem with your sideairbags or passenger’s side airbagautomatic cutoff system (see page
).
If you see any of these indications,your front or side airbags may notdeploy, your passenger’s side airbagautomatic cutoff system may notwork properly, or your seat belttensioners may not work when youneed them. See your Honda dealeras soon as possible.
54
How the SRS Indicator LightWorks
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver and Passenger Safety 53
Ignoring the SRS indicator lightcan result in serious injury ordeath if the airbags, cutoffsystem, or tensioners do notwork properly.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS light alerts you to apotential problem.
Information Provided by:
A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or other object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.
When you turn the ignition ON (II),the indicator should light briefly andgo out (see page ). If it doesn’tlight, stays on, or comes on whiledriving without a passenger in thefront seat, have the system checked.
If a small-statured adult leanssideways, or larger adult slouchesand leans sideways into thedeployment path of the side airbag,the system may also shut off the sideairbag.
This light alerts you thatthe passenger’s side airbag
has been automatically shut off.
It does not mean there is a problemwith your side airbags. It means thatthe side airbag cutoff system hasactivated to prevent the side airbagfrom deploying.
If the side airbag cutoff indicatorlight comes on, you should have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the deploymentpath of the side airbag, the systemwill turn the airbag back on and thelight will go out.
To reduce the risk of injury from aninflating side airbag, your vehicle hasan automatic cutoff system for thepassenger’s side airbag.
Although Honda does not encouragechildren to ride in the front, thissystem is designed to shut off theside airbag if a child leans sidewaysand the child’s head is in the sideairbag deployment path.
62
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver and Passenger Safety
How the Side Airbag CutoffIndicator Light Works
54
Information Provided by:
Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.
Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.
If rain or spilled watersoaks into a seat-back, it canprevent the side airbag systemfrom working properly.
See page for further informationand precautions relating to yourairbags.
Your front and side airbag systemsare virtually maintenance-free, andthere are no parts you can safelyservice. However, you must haveyour vehicle serviced if:
Anyairbag that has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit, automatic seat belttensioners, and other related parts.Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by a Honda dealer or aknowledgeable body shop.
Take your vehicle toan authorized Honda dealer assoon as possible. If you ignore thisindication, the airbags might notinflate when you need them.
Improperlyreplacing or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your sideairbags from inflating during acollision.
224
Airbag Service Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.
Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.
Do not expose the front seat-backsto water.
Your airbags ever inflate.
The SRS indicator light alerts youto a problem.
Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consulting aHonda dealer.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver and Passenger Safety 55
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle’s exhaust containscarbon monoxide gas. You shouldhave no problem with carbonmonoxide entering the vehicle innormal driving if you maintain yourvehicle properly.Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:
The vehicle is raised for an oilchange.You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.The vehicle was in an accidentthat may have damaged the under-side.
High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.
With the tailgate open, air flow canpull exhaust gas into your vehicle’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thetailgate open, open all the windowsand set the heating and coolingsystem/climate control system asshown below.
Select the Fresh Air mode.Select the mode.Turn the fan on high speed.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.
If you must sit in your parked vehicle,even in an unconfined area, with theengine running, adjust the heatingand cooling system/climate controlsystem as follows:
1.2.3.4.
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
Driver and Passenger Safety56
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.
Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.
Information Provided by:
These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury. Read these labels carefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hardto read, contact your Honda dealerfor a replacement.
U.S. models only U.S. models
Canadian models
Safety Labels
Driver and Passenger Safety 57
RADIATOR CAP
SUN VISOR
HOOD
DASHBOARD
BATTERY LABEL
Information Provided by:
58
Information Provided by:
This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour Honda. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.
...........................Control Locations . 60...............................Indicator Lights . 61
.............................................Gauges . 67Controls Near the Steering
.......................................Wheel . 71...................................Headlights . 72
Automatic Lighting Off.....................................Feature . 73
............Daytime Running Lights . 73....Instrument Panel Brightness . 73
................................Turn Signals . 74.....................Windshield Wipers . 74
..................Windshield Washers . 76Rear Window Wiper and
.....................................Washer . 76..........................Hazard Warning . 76
.............Rear Window Defogger . 77......Steering Wheel Adjustment . 78
...............................Keys and Locks . 79..............................................Keys . 79
....................Immobilizer System . 80............................Ignition Switch . 81
......................Power Door Locks . 82...................Remote Transmitter . 84
..............Childproof Door Locks . 87........................................Tailgate . 87
....................................Glove Box . 88.................................................Seats . 89
............Power Seat Adjustments . 89...........Driver’s Lumbar Support . 90..........Manual Seat Adjustments . 91
Second and Third Row seat............................Adjustments . 92..........................Head Restraints . 93........................Rear Seat Access . 94
............Folding the Second Seat . 94...............Folding the Third Seat . 95
...................Detachable Anchors . 97....................................Seat Heaters . 98
..............................Power Windows . 99...........................................Mirrors . 102
...............................Parking Brake . 104...........................Beverage Holder . 105
.................Console Compartment . 107.................................Cargo Hooks . 107
........................Sunglasses Holder . 108........................................Sun Visor . 109
................................Vanity Mirror . 109............Accessory Power Sockets . 110
........................................Coin Box . 111......................................Coat Hook . 111
...............................Interior Lights . 112
Instruments and Controls
Instruments and Controls 59
Information Provided by:
Control Locations
Instruments and Controls60
INDICATOR LIGHTS (P.61)GAUGES (P.67)
POWER DOOR LOCKSWITCHES(P.82)
MIRRORCONTROLS
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
HOOD RELEASEHANDLE
AUDIO SYSTEM
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
(P.103)
(P.99)
(P.218)
(P.110)
(P.137, 153. 168)
(P.118, 128)
FUEL FILL DOORRELEASE(P.217)
PARKING BRAKEPEDAL(P.104)
REAR A/C CONTROL(P.135)
Information Provided by:
*
*
*
The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.CONTINUED
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls 61
PARKING BRAKEAND BRAKE SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.63)
SIDE AIRBAGCUTOFF INDICATOR(P.62)
MALFUNCTION INDICATORLAMP
LOW OIL PRESSUREINDICATOR (P.62)
CHARGING SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.62)
DOOR AND TAILGATEOPEN MONITOR (P.64)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM INDICATOR (P.62)
VTM-4 INDICATOR (P.66)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.63)
HIGH BEAMINDICATOR (P.65)
A/T TEMPERATUREINDICATOR (P.66)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.63)
MAINTENANCEREQUIREDINDICATOR (P.69)
LOW FUELINDICATOR (P.65)
CRUISE CONTROLINDICATOR (P.65)
BRAKE LAMP INDICATOR (P.64)
SEAT BELT REMINDER LIGHT(P.62)
(P.349)
Information Provided by:
This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates that the passenger’s sideairbag has automatically shut off.For complete information, see page
.
The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your vehicle. This indicator lights when you turn
the ignition switch ON (II). If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates a potential problem withyour front airbags. This light willalso alert you to a potential problemwith your side airbags, passenger’sside airbag automatic cutoff systemor automatic seat belt tensioners.For complete information, see page
.
See page .
The engine can be severely damagedif this light flashes or stays on whenthe engine is running. For completeinformation, see page .
If this light comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged. For completeinformation, see page .
This indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch ON (II). It is areminder to you and your passengersto protect yourselves by fasteningthe seat belts. A beeper also soundsif you have not fastened your seatbelt.
If you do not fasten your seat belt,the beeper will stop after a fewseconds but the light stays on untilyou do. Both the light and the beeperstay off if you fasten your seat beltbefore turning on the ignition.
53
54
349
347
348
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls
Supplemental RestraintSystem Indicator
Malfunction IndicatorLamp
Low Oil PressureIndicator
Charging SystemIndicator
Seat Belt Reminder Light
Side Airbag CutoffIndicator
62
Information Provided by:
This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch ON (II). It will then go off ifyou have inserted a properly-codedignition key. If it is not a properly-coded key, the indicator will blinkand the engine will not start (seepage ).
This indicator also blinks severaltimes when you turn the ignitionswitch from ON (II) to ACCESSORY(I) or LOCK (0).
This light normally comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II), and whenthe ignition switch is turned toSTART (III). If this light comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe ABS. If this happens, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itchecked. With the light on, yourvehicle still has normal brakingability but no anti-lock. For completeinformation, see page .
This light has two functions:
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch ON (II). Itis a reminder to check the parkingbrake. Driving with the parkingbrake not fully released candamage the brakes and tires.
If the indicator remains lit afteryou have fully released theparking brake while the engine isrunning, or if it comes on whiledriving, it can indicate a problemin the brake system. For completeinformation, see page .
1.
2.
80
351
242
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls
Immobilizer SystemIndicator
Anti-lock Brake System(ABS) Indicator
Parking Brake and Brake SystemIndicator
63
U.S. Canada CanadaU.S.
Information Provided by:
The left or right turn signal lightblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If the light does not blink orblinks rapidly, it usually means oneof the turn signal bulbs is burned out(see page ). Replace the bulb assoon as possible, since other driverscannot see that you are signalling.
When you turn on the HazardWarning switch, both turn signallights blink. All turn signals on theoutside of the vehicle should flash.
The appropriate light comes on inthis display if the tailgate or any dooris not closed tightly.
All the lights in the monitor displaycome on for a few seconds when youturn the ignition switch ON (II).
If a brake light does not work, theindicator comes on
when you push the brake pedal withthe ignition switch ON (II).
A burned out brake light is a hazardwhen drivers behind you cannot tellyou are braking. Have your brakelights repaired right away.
318
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls
Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators
Door and Tailgate Open MonitorBrake Lamp Indicator
64
BRAKE LAMP
Information Provided by:
Canadian models only Canadian models onlyThis indicator lights when you turnthe ignition switch to ON (II) withthe headlight switch off and theparking brake set. It should go off ifyou turn on the headlights or releasethe parking brake. If it comes on atany other time, it means there is aproblem with the DRL. There mayalso be a problem with the highbeam headlights.
This light comes on with the highbeam headlights. See page forinformation on the headlightcontrols.
On Canadian models, this indicatorcomes on with reduced brightnesswhen the Daytime Running Lights(DRL) are on (see page ).
This lights when you set the cruisecontrol. See page for informationon operating the cruise control.
This light comes on when thewasher fluid level is low. Add washerfluid when you see this light come on(see page ).
This light comes on as a reminderthat you must refuel soon.
72
73
207
292
‘‘Daytime RunningLights’’ Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Cruise Control Indicator
Washer Level Indicator
Low Fuel Indicator
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls 65
Information Provided by:
This indicator monitors thetemperature of the automatictransmission fluid. The indicatorshould come on for a few secondswhen you turn the ignition switchON (II). If it comes on while driving,it indicates the transmission fluidtemperature is too high. Pull to theside of the road when it is safe, shiftto Park, and let the engine idle untilthe indicator goes out.
This light normally comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II). If this lightcomes on at any other time, there isa problem in the 4WD system. Takethe vehicle to your dealer to have itchecked.
If the indicator blinks while driving,pull to the side of the road when it issafe, shift to Park, and let the engineidle until the indicator goes out.
Indicator Lights
Instruments and Controls
A/T TemperatureIndicator
VTM-4 Indicator
66
Continuing to drive with the A/TTemperature indicator lit may causeserious damage to the transmission.
Continuing to drive with the VTM-4indicator blinking may cause seriousdamage to the system.
Information Provided by:
U.S. Models
Canadian Models
This shows your speed in miles perhour (mph). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in kilometersper hour (km/h).
This shows your speed in kilometersper hour (km/h). The smaller innernumbers are the speed in miles perhour (mph).
The tachometer shows the enginespeed in revolutions per minute(rpm). To protect the engine fromdamage, never drive with thetachometer needle in the red zone.
The odometer shows the total dis-tance your vehicle has been driven.It measures miles in U.S. models andkilometers in Canadian models.It is illegal under U.S. federal law andCanadian provincial regulations todisconnect, reset, or alter theodometer with the intent to changethe number of miles or kilometersindicated.
Speedometer
Odometer
Tachometer
Gauges
Instruments and Controls 67
TACHOMETER SPEEDOMETER FUEL GAUGE TEMPERATUREGAUGE
MAINTENANCEREQUIRED INDICATOR
TRIP METERSELECT/RESETBUTTONTRIP METER
ODOMETER
Information Provided by:
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it.
This shows how much fuel you have.It is most accurate when the vehicleis on level ground. It may showslightly more or less than the actualamount when you are driving oncurvy or hilly roads.
The needle returns to the bottomafter you turn off the ignition. Thegauge shows the fuel level readingimmediately after you turn theignition switch back ON (II).
There are two trip meters: Trip Aand Trip B. Switch between thesedisplays and the outside temperaturedisplay (EX model only) by pressingthe Select/Reset button repeatedly.Each trip meter works independently,so you can keep track of twodifferent distances.
To reset a trip meter, display it andthen press and hold the Select/Resetbutton until the number resets to‘‘0.0’’. Both trip meters will reset ifthe vehicle’s battery goes dead or isdisconnected.
This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the pointer should risefrom the bottom white mark to aboutthe middle white mark. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the pointer may rise to theupper white mark. If it reaches thered (Hot) mark, pull safely to theside of the road. Turn to page forinstructions and precautions onchecking the engine’s coolingsystem.
345
Trip Meter Fuel Gauge
Temperature Gauge
Instruments and Controls
Gauges
68
TRIP METER SELECT/RESET BUTTON
Avoid driving with an extremely lowfuel level. Running out of f uel couldcause the engine to misf ire, damagingthe catalytic converter.
Information Provided by:
This indicator reminds you that it istime to take your vehicle in forscheduled maintenance.Refer to the Maintenance Schedulesfor Normal and Severe DrivingConditions on pages and .
For the first 6,000 miles (9,600 km)after the Maintenance RequiredIndicator is reset, it will come on fortwo seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II).
Between 6,000 miles (9,600 km) and7,500 miles (12,000 km) thisindicator will light for two secondswhen you first turn the ignitionswitch ON (II), and then flash forten seconds.
If you exceed 7,500 miles (12,000km) without having the scheduledmaintenance performed, thisindicator will remain on as a constantreminder.
Your dealer will reset this indicatorafter completing the scheduledmaintenance. If this maintenance isdone by someone other than yourHonda dealer, reset the indicator asfollows.
Turn off the engine.
Press and hold the Select/Resetbutton on the instrument panel,then turn the ignition switch ON(II).
Hold the button for approximatelyten seconds until the indicatorresets.
1.
2.
3.
274 276
Gauges
Instruments and Controls
Maintenance Required Indicator
69
MAINTENANCE REQUIRED INDICATOR
SELECT/RESET BUTTON
Information Provided by:
This indicator displays the outsidetemperature in Fahrenheit in U.S.models, and in Centigrade inCanadian models. To see the outsidetemperature, press and release theSelect/Reset button until thetemperature is displayed.
The temperature sensor is located inthe front bumper. Therefore, thetemperature reading can be affectedby heat reflection from the road sur-face, engine heat, and the exhaustfrom surrounding traffic. This cancause an incorrect temperature read-ing when your speed is under19 mph (30 km/h).
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
On EX model
Instruments and Controls
Gauges
Outside Temperature Indicator
70
Information Provided by:
*
*The two levers on the steeringcolumn contain controls for drivingfeatures you use most often. The leftlever controls the turn signals,headlights, and high beams. Theright lever controls the windshieldwashers and wipers.
The switches for the hazard warninglights and rear window defogger arelocated to the right of the steeringcolumn.
The tilt adjustment lever on the leftside of the steering column allowsyou to tilt the steering wheel.
To use the horn, press the padaround the ‘‘H’’ logo.
Instruments and Controls
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
71
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNALS(P.72/74) VTM-4 LOCK
(P.77)
REMOTE AUDIOCONTROLS
(P.78)
HORN
(P.74/76)
LIGHT CONTROLSWITCH
HAZARDWARNINGLIGHTS
CRUISE CONTROL
REARWINDOWDEFOGGER
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENT
CRUISECONTROL
WINDSHIELDWIPERS/WASHERS
(P.112)
(P.207)
(P.188)
(P.207)
(P.238)(P.77)
Information Provided by:
If you leave the lights on with theignition switch in ACCESSORY (I)or LOCK (0), you will hear areminder chime when you open thedriver’s door.
The rotating switch on the left levercontrols the lights. Turning thisswitch to the ‘‘ ’’ position turnson the parking lights, taillights,instrument panel lights, side-markerlights, and rear license plate lights.Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights.
To change from low beams to highbeams, push the turn signal leverforward until you hear a click. Theblue high beam indicator will light(see page ). To return to lowbeams, pull the turn signal leverback.
To flash the high beams, pull theturn signal lever back lightly, thenrelease it. The high beams will comeon and go off.
The high beams will stay on for aslong as you hold the lever back, nomatter what position the headlightswitch is in.65
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls
Headlights
72
Information Provided by:
The lights will turn on again whenyou unlock or open the driver’s door.If you unlock the door, but do notopen it within 15 seconds, the lightswill go off. With the driver’s dooropen, you will hear a lights-onreminder chime.
With the headlight switch off, thehigh beam headlights come on withreduced brightness when you turnthe ignition switch to ON (II) andrelease the parking brake. Theyremain on until you turn the ignitionoff, even if you set the parking brake.
The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.
This feature activates if you leavethe headlight switch in the or
position, remove the key, open,then close the driver’s door.If you remove the key from theignition switch with the headlightswitch on, but do not open the doorand get out, the lights will turn offafter 10 minutes.
The Automatic Lighting Off featureturns off the headlights, fog lights,parking lights, taillights, side markerlights, license plate lights andinstrument panel lights within 15seconds of removing the key fromthe ignition switch and closing thedriver’s door.
The knob on the instrument panelcontrols the brightness of the instru-ment panel lights. Turn the knob toadjust the brightness.
On EX model
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls
Automatic Lighting Off Feature
Daytime Running Lights(Canadian Models)
Instrument Panel Brightness
73
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESSCONTROL KNOB
Information Provided by:
Signal a turn or lane change with thislever. Push down on the lever tosignal a left turn, and up to signal aright turn. If you push it up or downall the way, the turn signal continuesto blink even when you release thelever. It shuts off automatically asyou complete the turn.
To signal a lane change, push lightlyon the turn signal lever in the properdirection and hold it. The lever willreturn to the center position as soonas you release it.
This lever controls the windshieldwipers and washers. It has fivepositions:
MIST: mistOFF: offINT: intermittentLO: low speedHI: high speed
To select a position, push the leverup or down.
Turn Signals Windshield Wipers
Instruments and Controls
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
74
TURN SIGNAL LEVER
Information Provided by:
To operate the wipers in mist mode,push the control lever up from theOFF position. The wipers run at highspeed until you release the lever.This gives you a quick way to clearthe windshield.
You can vary how often the wiperssweep the windshield by turning theINT TIME ring next to the rotaryswitch.
In intermittent, the wipers operateevery few seconds. The sweepinterval will change slightly withspeed; getting shorter as you drivefaster. In low speed and high speed,the wipers run continuously.
If you turn the INT TIME ring to theshortest delay, the wipers willchange from intermittent to lowspeed operation when vehicle speedexceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls 75
Information Provided by:
To clean the windshield, pull back onthe wiper control lever. The washersspray until you release the lever. Thewipers run at low speed while you’repulling the lever, then complete onemore sweep of the windshield afteryou release it.
To turn on the rear window wiper,turn the rotary switch clockwise toON. To also use the rear windowwasher, turn the rotary switchclockwise past ON. The washer willspray as long as you hold the rotaryswitch in this position. If you turn therotary switch counterclockwise fromthe OFF position, the washer willspray without activating the rearwindow wiper.
Push the red button to turn on thehazard warning lights (four-wayflashers). This causes all fouroutside turn signals and bothindicators in the instrument panel toflash. Use the hazard warning lightsif you need to park in a dangerousarea near heavy traffic, or if yourvehicle is disabled.
Hazard WarningRear Window Wiper and WasherWindshield Washers
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls76
Information Provided by:
The rear window defogger will clearfog, frost, and thin ice from thewindow. Push the defogger button toturn it on and off. The light abovethe button lights to show thedefogger is on. If you do not turn itoff, the defogger will shut itself offafter about 15 minutes. It also shutsoff when you turn off the ignition.You have to turn it on again whenyou restart the vehicle.
Make sure the rear window is clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.
The defogger wires on the inside ofthe rear window can be accidentallydamaged. When cleaning the glass,always wipe side to side.
Rear Window Defogger
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls 77
EX model LX model
Information Provided by:
Push the lever up to lock thesteering wheel in that position.
Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up and down.
To adjust the steering wheel upwardor downward:
Push the lever under the steeringcolumn all the way down.
Move the steering wheel to thedesired position, making sure thewheel points toward your chest,not toward your face. Make sureyou can see the instrument panelgauges and the indicator lights.
Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.
3.
4.
1.
2.
See page for important safetyinformation about how to properlyposition the steering wheel.
18
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
Instruments and Controls
Steering Wheel Adjustment
78
Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thevehicle and be seriously injuredin a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the vehicle is stopped.
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle comes with two masterkeys and a valet key.The master key fits all the locks onyour vehicle:• Ignition• Driver’s Door• Glove box
The valet key works only in theignition and the door locks. You cankeep the glove box locked when youleave your vehicle and valet key at aparking facility.
These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theImmobilizer System. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.
Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry them immedi-ately with a soft cloth.
The keys do not contain batteries.Do not try to take them apart.
Your vehicle also comes with tworemote transmitters; see page foran explanation of their operation.
You should have received a keynumber plate with your keys. Youwill need this key number if you everhave to get a lost key replaced. Keepthe plate stored in a safe place. If youneed to replace a key, use onlyHonda-approved key blanks.
84
CONTINUED
Keys
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls
Remote Transmitter
79
KEYNUMBERPLATE
MASTERKEYS(BLACK)
VALET KEY(GRAY)
Information Provided by:
The Immobilizer System protectsyour vehicle from theft. A properly-coded master or valet key must beused in the ignition switch for theengine to start. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used,the engine’s fuel system is disabled.
When you turn the ignition switch toON (II), the Immobilizer Systemindicator should come on for a fewseconds, then go out. If the indicatorstarts to blink, it means the systemdoes not recognize the coding of thekey. Turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0), remove the key, reinsertit, and turn the switch to ON (II)again.
The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object is near theignition switch when you insert thekey. To make sure the systemrecognizes the key code:
Do not keep other immobilizerkeys on the same key ring.
Use a plastic or leather key fob,not metal.
Keep other keys away from yourvehicle’s key and the ignitionswitch while trying to start theengine.
The Immobilizer System indicatorwill also blink several times whenyou turn the ignition switch from ON(II) to ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0).
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour vehicle undriveable.
If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your Honda dealer.
If you have lost your key and youcannot start the engine, contact yourHonda dealer.
Immobilizer System
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls80
Information Provided by:
-
If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may sometimes makeit difficult to turn the key fromLOCK to ACCESSORY. Firmly turnthe steering wheel to the left or tothe right as you turn the key.
You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To switch from ACCESSORY toLOCK, you must push the key inslightly as you turn it. The shift levermust also be in Park. The anti-theftlock will lock the steering columnwhen you remove the key.
The ignition switch is on the rightside of the steering column. It hasfour positions:• LOCK (0)• ACCESSORY (I)• ON (II)• START (III)
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
CONTINUED
LOCK (0)Ignition Switch
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls 81
Information Provided by:
-
-
- Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to ON (II) when you let go ofthe key.
This is the normal keyposition when driving. All featuresand accessories on the vehicle areusable. Several of the lights on theinstrument panel come on as a testwhen you turn the ignition switchfrom ACCESSORY to ON.
The engine will not start if theImmobilizer System does notrecognize the key’s coding (see page
).
You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I) position and openthe driver’s door. Remove the key toturn off the beeper.
In this position,you can operate the audio systemand the accessory power sockets.
Each front door has a master doorlock switch. Either switch locks andunlocks all doors and the tailgate.Push the top of the switch to unlockall doors and the tailgate, and thebottom to lock them.
80
START (III) Power Door Locks
ON (II)
ACCESSORY (I)
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls82
MASTER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
Information Provided by:
Each door has a lock tab on the top.When you push down the lock tab onthe driver’s door, all the doors andthe tailgate lock. Pulling up the locktab on the driver’s door unlocks onlythat door. The lock tabs on the otherdoors lock and unlock only that door.
To lock the front passenger’s doorwhen getting out of the vehicle, pushthe lock tab down and close the door.To lock the driver’s door, along with
the remaining doors and the tailgate,push the lock tab down or push themaster switch down, then close thedoor.
All doors and the tailgate can belocked from the outside by using thekey in the driver’s door. To unlockonly the driver’s door from theoutside, turn the key and release it.If you turn the key and hold it, alldoors and the tailgate will unlock. Allfour doors and the tailgate willunlock when you unlock thepassenger’s door with the key.
If you forget and leave the key in theignition switch, Lockout Preventionwill not allow you to lock the driver’sdoor. With the driver’s door openand the key in the ignition, bothmaster door lock switches aredisabled. However, if the driver’sdoor is not open, the master doorlock switches are not disabled.Pushing the switch down on theopen passenger’s door will lock alldoors. If you try to lock an opendriver’s door by pushing down thelock tab, the tabs on all doors pop out.Pushing down the lock tab on thepassenger’s door only locks that door.
Lockout Prevention
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls 83
LOCK TAB
Information Provided by:
You can lock and unlock your vehiclewith the remote transmitter. Whenyou push the LOCK button, all doorsand the tailgate lock. The parkinglights, side marker lights, taillightsand instrument panel lights flashonce.
When you push the LOCK button asecond time within 5 seconds afteryou have locked the doors, you willhear a beep to verify that thesecurity system has set.
When you push the UNLOCK buttononce, only the driver’s door unlocks.The remaining doors and the tailgateunlock when you push the button asecond time. The parking lights, sidemarker lights, taillights andinstrument panel lights flash twicewhen you push the button.
When you press the UNLOCKbutton, the front and rear individualmap lights and the cargo area light,depending on their switch positions,will come on (see page ). If youdo not open any door or the tailgate,the lights stay on for about 10seconds, then go out. If you relockthe doors and the tailgate with theremote transmitter before 10seconds have elapsed, the lights will
go off immediately.
If you unlock the doors and thetailgate with the remote transmitter,but do not open any door or thetailgate within 30 seconds, all doorsand the tailgate automatically relock.
You cannot lock the doors and thetailgate with the remote transmitterif any door or the tailgate is not fullyclosed. You cannot lock or unlockthe doors and the tailgate with thekey in the ignition switch.
112
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls
Remote Transmitter
84
LED LOCKBUTTON
UNLOCKBUTTON
PANICBUTTON
Information Provided by:
Panic mode allows you to remotelyactivate your vehicle’s horn andlights to attract attention. Whenactivated, the horn will sound, andthe headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights, taillights andinstrument panel lights will flash forabout 30 seconds. To activate panicmode, press and hold the PANICbutton for about one second.
When the remote transmitter’sbattery begins to get weak, it maytake several pushes on the button tolock or unlock the doors and thetailgate, and the LED will get dim.Replace the battery as soon aspossible.
Battery type: CR2025
To cancel Panic mode before 30seconds, press any button on theremote transmitter. You can alsoturn the ignition switch to ON (II).
Panic mode will not activate if thekey is in the ON (II) position.
To replace the battery, remove theround cover on the back of the trans-mitter by turning it counterclockwisewith a coin.
CONTINUED
Panic Mode Replacing the Battery
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls 85
ROUNDCOVER
BATTERY
Information Provided by:
+
◎▽
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Avoid severe shock to the trans-mitter, such as dropping or throwingit. Also, protect it from extreme hotor cold temperatures.
Clean the transmitter case with asoft cloth. Do not use strongcleaners or solvents that could harmthe case. Immersing the transmitterin any liquid will harm the trans-mitter and cause it to not functionproperly.
Remove the old battery and note thepolarity. Make sure the polarity ofthe new battery is the same ( sidefacing up), then insert it in thetransmitter.
Align the mark on the coverwith the mark on thetransmitter, then set the cover inplace and turn it clockwise.
If you lose a transmitter, you willneed to have the replacementprogrammed to your vehicle’ssystem by your Honda dealer. Anyother transmitters you have will alsoneed to be reprogrammed.
Transmitter Care
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls86
Information Provided by:
See page for information oncargo loading. Keep the tailgateclosed at all times while driving toavoid damaging the tailgate and toprevent exhaust gas from gettinginto the interior. See
on page .
To open the tailgate, pull the handle,then lift up the tailgate.
The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position, the doorcannot be opened from the insideregardless of the position of the locktab. To open the door, pull the locktab up and use the outside doorhandle.
To close the tailgate, use the innerhandle to pull the tailgate down, thenpress down on the back edge.
56
225
CarbonMonoxide Hazard
Childproof Door Locks Tailgate
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls 87
LOCK LEVER HANDLE
Information Provided by:
Open the glove box by pulling thebottom of the handle. Close it with afirm push. Lock or unlock the glovebox with the master key.
The glove box light comes on onlywhen the parking lights are on.
Glove Box
Keys and Locks
Instruments and Controls88
GLOVE BOX
An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.
Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.
Information Provided by:
-
Pull up or push down on the front ofthe switch to move the seat bottom’sfront edge up or down. Pull up orpush down on the rear of the switchto move the rear of the seat bottomup or down.Push the horizontal switch forward
or backward to move the seatforward or backward.
The long horizontal switch adjuststhe seat bottom in several directions.The short vertical switch adjusts theseat-back angle.
The EX model has a poweradjustable driver’s seat. The twopower seat adjustment switches areon the outside edge of the seatbottom. All other seats in the EXmodel have manual adjustments.
All seats in the LX model adjustmanually.
You can adjust the power seat withthe ignition switch in any position.Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.
12 13
CONTINUED
Power Seat Adjustments
Seats
Instruments and Controls 89
Information Provided by:
Pull the center of the horizontalswitch up to raise the seat. Push itdown to lower the seat.
Adjust the seat-back angle bypushing the rear switch in thedirection you want to move. Vary the lumbar support by moving
the lever on the right side of theseat-back. Move the lever forward orbackward to adjust the lumbarsupport through its full range.
On EX modelDriver’s Lumbar Support
Seats
Instruments and Controls90
Information Provided by:
-
To adjust the seat forward andbackward, pull up on the lever underthe seat cushion’s front edge. Movethe seat to the desired position andrelease the lever. Try to move theseat to make sure it is locked inposition.
To change the seat-back angle of thefront seats, pull up on the lever onthe outside of the seat bottom.
Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.
12 13Manual Seat Adjustments
Seats
Instruments and Controls 91
Information Provided by:
To adjust the seat-back angle of thethird seat, pull on the handle on theback of the seat-back, move the seat-back to the desired position, andrelease the handle. Let the seat-backlatch in the new position.
To change the seat-back angle of theseats in the second row, pull up onthe handle on the outside of the seat-back.
The height of your driver’s seat isadjustable. Turn the front dial on theoutside of the seat cushion to raisethe front of the seat bottom, and turnthe rear dial to raise the rear.
On LX model
Seats
Instruments and Controls
Second and Third Row SeatAdjustments
Driver’s Seat Manual HeightAdjustment
92
SECONDSEAT
THIRDSEAT HANDLE
Information Provided by:
See page for important safetyinformation and a warning about how toproperly position the head restraints.
14To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release buttonand pull the restraint out of the seat-back.
The head restraints help protect youand your passengers from whiplashand other injuries. They are mosteffective when you adjust them sothe back of the occupant’s head restsagainst the center of the restraint. Ataller person should adjust therestraint as high as possible.
Your vehicle is equipped with headrestraints in all seating positions.
The head restraints in the secondand third row seats adjust for height.You need both hands to adjust therestraint. To raise it, pull upward. Tolower the restraint, push the releasebutton sideways and push therestraint down.
Head Restraints
Seats
Instruments and Controls 93
RELEASE BUTTON
Information Provided by:
To get into the third row seats, pullup the lever on the side of thepassenger’s side second row seat-back. The seat-back will tilt forward,and the seat will slide forward.
After you return the seat-back to theupright position, push the whole seatbackwards until it latches. Makesure the seat is fully latched beforesitting in it.
The left and right halves of thesecond seat can be folded upseparately to create more cargospace.
If you are folding the left half ofthe seat, use the ignition key torelease the center seat belt fromthe detachable anchor. Allow theseat belt to retract into the roof.Insert the latch plate into the roofholder.
Fold the seat-back forward.
Reverse this procedure to return theseat to the upright position. Makesure the seat is locked securelybefore driving.
(Left half) Remove the center seatbelt from its holder in the roof, andconnect it to the detachable anchor(see page ).
Pull up the handle on the outsideof the seat-back.
Lower the head restraint to itslowest position.
2.
3.
1.
4.
97
Rear Seat Access Folding the Second Seat
Seats
Instruments and Controls94
HANDLE
RELEASE LEVER
Information Provided by:
Store the head restraints in thestorage compartment under thecargo area floor. Insert the shaftsof the head restraints into theholes in the sides of the storagecompartment.
Use the ignition key to release theseat belt from the detachableanchor.
To create more cargo space, you canfold the third seat forward.To fold the third seat:
Remove the head restraints bypushing the release buttons andpulling the restraints out.
1.
2. 3.
CONTINUED
Folding the Third Seat
Seats
Instruments and Controls 95
Information Provided by:
Unlock the seat-back by pullingthe handle. Push the seat-backforward.
Make sure you clip the small latchplate of each outer shoulder belt tothe seat belt webbing whenever thethird seat is folded.
Reverse this procedure to return theseat to the upright position. Makesure the seat is locked securelybefore driving.
Reinstall the head restraints.Reconnect the seat belts to thedetachable anchors.
Make sure all items in the cargo areaare secured. Loose items can flyforward and cause injury if you haveto brake hard. Seeon page .
4.
225
Seats
Instruments and Controls
Carrying Cargo
96
HANDLE
Information Provided by:
When the seat-back is returned to itsupright position, be sure to latch thedetachable anchor by lining up thetriangle marks on the small latchplate and buckle and inserting theplate into the buckle. Tug on the seatbelt to make sure the detachableanchor is securely attached.
To unlatch the detachable anchorbefore folding down a seat-back,insert a key into the slot on the sideof the small buckle and allow theseat belt to retract.
Once the seat belt has completelyretracted, secure the latch plates. Inthe second row, the latch platesshould be placed into their holdingslots in the ceiling. In the third row,the small latch plate should beclipped to the seat belt webbing.
The seat belts in the center seat ofthe second row and in all of the thirdrow seats are equipped with adetachable seat belt anchor thatallows the seat belt to be unlatchedwhen the seats are folded down.
CONTINUED
Detachable Anchors
Seats
Instruments and Controls 97
SMALL LATCH PLATE
TRIANGULAR MARK
Using a seat belt with thedetachable anchor unlatchedincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt,make sure the detachableanchor is correctly latched.
Information Provided by:
Follow these precautions wheneveryou use the seat heaters:
Use the HI setting only to heat theseats quickly. Select the LOsetting when the seats feel warm.The HI setting draws largeamounts of current from thebattery.
Do not use the seat heaters, evenon the LO setting, if the engine isleft idling for an extended period.They can weaken the battery,causing hard starting.
The HI or LO indicator lights andremains lit until you turn it off bypushing the opposite side of theswitch lightly. The indicator will turnoff.
In HI, the heater turns off when theseat gets warm, and turns back onafter the seat’s temperature drops. Itcontinues to cycle as long as youleave it set on HI. The HI indicatorremains lit as a reminder that youhave the heater on.
In LO, the heater runs continuously.It does not cycle with temperaturechanges.
Because of the sensors for the sideairbag system, there is no heater inthe passenger’s seat-back.
Both front seats are equipped withseat heaters. The ignition switchmust be ON (II) to use them. Pushthe front of the switch, HI, to rapidlyheat up the seat. After the seatreaches a comfortable temperature,select LO by pushing the back of theswitch. This will keep the seat warm.
On Canadian EX model with leatherseats
Seat Heaters
Instruments and Controls98
SEAT HEATERS
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle’s windows areelectrically-powered. Turn theignition switch to ON (II) to raise orlower any window.
Each door has a switch that controlsits window. To open the window,push the switch down and hold it.Release the switch when you wantthe window to stop. Close thewindow by pulling back on theswitch and holding it.
The driver’s door armrest has amaster power window control panel.To open any of the passenger’swindows, push down on the switchand hold it down until the windowreaches the desired position. Toclose the window, pull back on thewindow switch. Release the switchwhen the window gets to the positionyou want.
CONTINUED
Power Windows
Instruments and Controls 99
DRIVER’S WINDOWSWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
Information Provided by:
-
The master control panel also con-tains these extra features:
To open the driver’swindow fully, push the windowswitch firmly down and release it.The window automatically goes allthe way down. To stop the windowfrom going all the way down, pullback on the window switch briefly.
The MAIN switch controls power tothe front passenger’s window andthe rear power windows. With thisswitch off, the passenger’s windowscannot be raised or lowered. TheMAIN switch does not affect thedriver’s window. Keep the MAINswitch off when you have children inthe vehicle so they do not injurethemselves by operating thewindows unintentionally.
To close the driver’s window fully,pull back the window switch firmly,then release it. The windowautomatically goes all the way up. Tostop the window from going all theway up, push down on the windowswitch briefly.
To open or close the driver’s windowpartially, push down or pull back onthe window switch lightly and hold it.The window will stop when yourelease the switch.
AUTO
Power Windows
Instruments and Controls100
Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.
Information Provided by:
The power window system has a key-off delay function. The windows willstill operate for up to ten minutesafter you turn off the ignition.Opening either front door cancelsthe delay function. You must turnthe ignition switch ON (II) againbefore you can operate the windows.
If the driver’s window runs into anyobstacle while it is closingautomatically, it will reversedirection, and then stop. To close thewindow, remove the obstacle, thenuse the window switch again.
Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, or thedriver’s window fuse is removed, theAUTO function will be disabled. Thepower window system needs to bereset after reconnecting the batteryor installing the fuse. You should dothe following.
Start the engine. Push down onthe driver’s window switch untilthe window is fully open.
Pull back on the driver’s windowswitch to close the windowcompletely, then hold the switchfor a second or two more.
If the power windows do not operateproperly after resetting, have yourvehicle checked by a Honda dealer.
1.
2.
Power Windows
Instruments and Controls
Auto Reverse
101
Information Provided by:
Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.
The inside mirror has day and nightpositions. The night position reducesglare from headlights behind you.Flip the tab on the bottom edge ofthe mirror to select the day or nightposition.
Mirrors
Instruments and Controls102
TAB
Information Provided by:
Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).
Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.
When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns off theadjustment switch so you can’tmove a mirror out of position byaccidentally bumping the switch.
Adjust the outside mirrors with theadjustment switch on the driver’sdoor armrest:
The outside mirrors are heated to re-move fog and frost. With the ignitionswitch ON (II), turn on the heatersby pressing the button. The light inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Available on Canadian models
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
Mirrors
Instruments and Controls 103
HEATED MIRROR BUTTONSELECTOR SWITCH ADJUSTMENT SWITCH
Information Provided by:
To apply the parking brake, push theparking brake pedal down with yourfoot. To release the parking brake,push on the pedal again. The parkingbrake light on the instrument panelshould go out when the parkingbrake is fully released with theengine running. (see page .)63
Instruments and Controls
Parking Brake
104
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
Driving the vehicle with the parkingbrake applied can damage the rearbrakes and axles.
Information Provided by:
Spilled liquids can also damage theupholstery, carpeting, and electricalcomponents in the interior.
Be careful when you are using thebeverage holders. A spilled liquidthat is very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Liquid can also spillfrom the rear door pocket beverageholders when you close the reardoors. Use only resealablecontainers in the door pockets.
To open the front beverage holder,push the lock lever and slide the lidforward.
The second row seat has a beverageholder and tray in the center armrest.To use it, pivot the armrest down.
CONTINUED
Beverage Holders
Instruments and Controls
Second Row Center Armrest
105
Information Provided by:
Instruments and Controls
Third Row Seat ArmrestRear Door Pocket
Beverage Holders
106
Information Provided by:
The hooks on the floor of the cargoarea enable you to tie down itemsstored in the back. Make sure allstored items are secured beforedriving.
To open the console compartment,pull up on the lever and lift the lid.To close, lower the lid and push itdown until it latches.
You can store a cellular phone, asmall notepad, and business cards inthe front of the consolecompartment. To open the frontdoor of the console compartment,pull up the lever, and pivot the doorforward.
Console Compartment Cargo Hooks
Console Compartment, Cargo Hooks
Instruments and Controls 107
Information Provided by:
To open the sunglasses holder, pushon the front edge. It will unlatch andswing down. To close it, push it untilit latches. Make sure the holder isclosed while you are driving.
Some larger styles of sunglassesmay not fit in the holder.
Sunglasses Holder
Instruments and Controls108
Information Provided by:
To use the sun visor, pull it down.You can also use the sun visor at theside window. Remove the supportrod from the clip and swing the sunvisor toward the side window. In thisposition, the sun visor can beextended by sliding out theextension.
To use a vanity mirror on the back ofthe sun visor, pull up the cover.
Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the vehicle. Do not usethe sun visor extension over the rearview mirror.
The light beside the mirror comeson only when the parking lights orheadlights are on.
Sun Visor Vanity Mirror
Sun Visor, Vanity Mirror
Instruments and Controls 109
EXTENSION
SUN VISOR
Information Provided by:
To use the socket in the consolecompartment, pull the cover up.
To use an accessory power socket,the ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).
Your vehicle has four accessorypower sockets. The front accessorypower socket is located under theaudio system.Two more sockets arelocated in the center consolecompartment and on the back of thecenter console. The fourth socket isbehind the third seat on the driver’sside.
These sockets are intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps).
When more than one socket is beingused, the combined power rating ofthe accessories should be 120 wattsor less (10 amps).
Accessory Power Sockets
Instruments and Controls110
FRONT
Information Provided by:
The coin box is located under theaudio system. To open the coin box,pull the bottom edge. Close it with afirm push.
The rear socket has a maximumpower rating of 120 watts (10 amps.)
None of the sockets will power anautomotive type cigarette lighterelement.
The second and third row grab railscan also be used as coat hooks.
Instruments and Controls
Coin Box Coat Hook
Accessory Power Sockets, Coin Box, Coat Hook
111
Information Provided by:
When this switch is in the OFFposition:
None of the lights come on when adoor or the tailgate is opened.
The individual map lights in thefront can be turned on and off withthe switches next to the lights.
The individual map lights in thefront come on when any door orthe tailgate is opened. When thedoors and the tailgate are closed,each light can be turned on and offwith the switch next to the light.
When the switch is in the DoorActivated position:
The light control switch controls theinterior lights: the individual maplights by the sun visors, and theindividual map lights above thesecond and third row passengers.This switch has three positions: OFF,Door Activated, and ON.
The individual map lights in thesecond and third rows cannot beturned on.
The individual map lights in thesecond and third rows come onwhen any door or the tailgate isopened. When the doors and thetailgate are closed, each light canbe turned on and off by pushingon the lens.
Light Control Switch
Interior Lights
Instruments and Controls112
ON
DOORACTIVATEDPOSITION OFF
Information Provided by:
The lights go out about six secondsafter all the doors and the tailgateare closed.
With the light control switch in theDoor Activated position, all theindividual map lights come on whenyou unlock the door with the remotetransmitter (see page ).
With any door or the tailgate leftopen, the lights stay on about threeminutes, then go out.
When the switch is in the ONposition:
All the individual map lights come onand stay on as long as the switchremains in the ON position.
84
Interior Lights
Instruments and Controls 113
Information Provided by:
Turn on the front individual maplights by pushing the button next toeach light. Push the button again toturn it off. You can also operatethese lights with the light controlswitch (see page ).
Turn on the grab rail light bypushing the lens on each light. Pushthe lens again to turn the light off.You can also operate these lightswith the light control switch (seepage ).
The light in the tailgate has an on-offswitch. When the switch is in the ONposition, the light comes on whenthe tailgate is opened.
112 112
Individual Map Lights Tailgate Light
Interior Lights
Instruments and Controls114
FRONT GRAB RAIL
Information Provided by:
The ignition switch light comes onwhen you open the driver’s door, andstays on several seconds after youclose the door.
The courtesy lights in the frontdoors come on whenever you openeither front door.
Interior Lights
Instruments and Controls
Ignition Switch Light Courtesy Lights
115
Information Provided by:
116
Information Provided by:
.....................Heating and Cooling . 118.........What Each Control Does . 118
............How to Use the System . 122..........To Turn Everything Off . 127
...............Climate Control System . 128(EX model)
.......Fully-automatic Operation . 130
.......Semi-automatic Operation . 131Sunlight Sensor/
............Temperature Sensor . 134...........................Rear A/C Unit . 135
.......................Audio System (LX) . 137AM/FM/CD
........................Audio System . 137.................Operating the Radio . 137.................Adjusting the Sound . 141
..............................Digital Clock . 142............Audio System Lighting . 143
.........Operating the CD Player . 143.....Operating the CD Changer . 145....CD Player Error Indications . 147
CD Changer Error.............................Indications . 148
Operating the Cassette.....................................Player . 149
............Tape Search Functions . 151
.......................Audio System (EX) . 153AM/FM/Cassette/CD Audio
....................................System . 153.................Operating the Radio . 154.................Adjusting the Sound . 158
..............................Digital Clock . 159............Audio System Lighting . 159
Operating the Cassette.....................................Player . 160
............Tape Search Functions . 162.........Operating the CD Player . 163
.....Operating the CD Changer . 165....CD Player Error Indications . 166
CD Changer Error.............................Indications . 167
Audio System (Optional on U.S...............................EX model) . 168
AM/FM/Cassette/CD/DVD........................Audio System . 168
.................Operating the Radio . 170
.................Adjusting the Sound . 174..............................Digital Clock . 175
............Audio System Lighting . 175....................Radio Frequencies . 176
........................Radio Reception . 176
Operating the Cassette.....................................Player . 178
Caring for the Cassette.....................................Player . 181
.........Operating the CD Player . 182.....Operating the CD Changer . 184
.......Protecting Compact Discs . 185....CD Player Error Indications . 186
CD Changer Error.............................Indications . 187
...........Remote Audio Controls . 188.......................Theft Protection . 189
........Rear Entertainment System . 190............................Security System . 206
...............................Cruise Control . 207HomeLink Universal
................................Transceiver . 210
Comfort and Convenience Features
Comfort and Convenience Features 117
Information Provided by:
Proper use of the Heating andCooling system can make theinterior dry and comfortable, andkeep the windows clear for bestvisibility.
Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe fan’s speed, which increases airflow.
Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe temperature of the air flow.
This button turns the air condi-tioning ON and OFF. The indicatorin the button lights when the A/C ison.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
What Each Control Does
Fan Control Dial
Temperature Control Dial
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button
On LX model
118
TEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
FAN CONTROLDIAL
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
AIR CONDITIONINGBUTTON
MODE CONTROL DIAL
Information Provided by:
This button controls the source ofthe air going into the system. Whenthe indicator in this button is lit, airfrom the vehicle’s interior is sentthrough the system again (Recircula-tion mode). When the indicator is off,air is brought in from outside thevehicle (Fresh Air mode).
This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).
Use the MODE control dial to selectthe vents the air flows from. Someair will flow from the dashboardcorner vents in all modes.
Air flows from the centerand corner vents in the dashboard.
Air flow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard and thefloor vents.
Air flows from the floorvents.
Air flow is divided betweenthe floor vents and the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.
Air flows from the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.
When you select or ,the system automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C. In this case you cannot turn itoff.
When you select , the systemautomatically switches to Fresh Airmode and turns on the A/C.
77
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
Recirculation Button
Rear Window Defogger Button
Mode Control Dial
119
Information Provided by:
You can adjust the direction of theair coming from the centerdashboard vents by moving the tabin the center of each vent up-and-down and side-to-side.
The direction of the air coming fromthe corner vents can be adjusted bymoving the tab in the center of eachvent up-and-down.
The corner vents can be opened andclosed with the dials underneaththem.
You can also adjust the direction ofthe air coming from the rear centervents by moving the tab in the centerof each vent up-and-down and side-to-side.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
Vent Controls
120
CENTER VENTS CORNER VENT REAR CENTER VENT
Information Provided by:
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
121
Information Provided by:
This section covers how to set up thesystem controls for ventilation,heating, cooling, dehumidifying, anddefrosting.
The engine must be running for theheater and air conditioning togenerate hot and cold air. The heateruses engine coolant to warm the air.If the engine is cold, it will be severalminutes before you feel warm aircoming from the system.
The air conditioning does not rely onengine temperature.It is best to leave the system in FreshAir mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in Recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.Switch to Recirculation mode whenyou are driving through smoky ordusty conditions, then switch back toFresh Air mode when the conditionclears.
The outside air intakes for theheating and cooling system are atthe base of the windshield. Keepthese clear of leaves and otherdebris.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
How to Use the System
122
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
FAN CONTROLDIAL
TEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
MODE CONTROL DIALAIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
Information Provided by:
The flow-through ventilation systemdraws in outside air, circulates itthrough the interior, then exhausts itthrough vents near the rear sidepanels.
Turn the temperature control dialall the way to the left.Make sure the A/C is off.Select and Fresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.
If the interior is very warm frombeing parked in the sun, you can coolit down more rapidly by setting upthe controls this way:
When the interior has cooled downto a more comfortable temperature,close the windows and set thecontrols as described for normalcooling.
Air conditioning places an extra loadon the engine. Watch the enginecoolant temperature gauge (see page
) when driving in stop-and-gotraffic or climbing a long, steep hill.If it moves near the red zone, turnoff the A/C until the gauge readsnormally.
Turn on the A/C by pressing thebutton. The light in the buttoncomes on when a fan speed isselected.Make sure the temperaturecontrol dial is all the way to the left.Select .If the outside air is humid, selectRecirculation mode. If the outsideair is dry, select Fresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.
Start the engine.Turn on the A/C by pressing thebutton. Make sure the tempera-ture control dial is turned all theway to the left.Set the fan to maximum speed.Open the windows partially. Select
and Fresh Air mode.
1.
2.3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
5.
4.
1.2.
3.
68
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
Ventilation To Cool with A/C
123
Information Provided by:
To warm the interior:
Start the engine.Select and Fresh Air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.Adjust the warmth of the air withthe temperature control dial.
1.2.3.4.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
To Heat
124
MODE CONTROL DIAL
TEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
FAN CONTROLDIAL
AIR CONDITIONINGBUTTON
Information Provided by:
Air conditioning, as it cools, removesmoisture from the air. When used incombination with the heater, itmakes the interior warm and dry.
This setting is suitable for all drivingconditions whenever the outsidetemperature is above 32°F (0°C).
To remove fog from the inside of thewindows:
To remove exterior frost or ice fromthe windshield and side windowsafter the vehicle has been sitting outin cold weather:
Switch the fan on.Turn on the air conditioningSelect and Fresh Air mode.Adjust the temperature controldial so the mixture of heated andcooled air feels comfortable.
Set the fan to the desired speed.Select .When you select , thesystem automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C.Adjust the temperature controldial so the air flow from thedefroster vents feels warm.Turn on the rear window defoggerto help clear the rear window.When you switch to another modefrom , the A/C stays on.Press the A/C button to turn it off.
Start the engine.Select .When you select , thesystem automatically switches toFresh Air mode and turns on theA/C.Set the fan and temperaturecontrols to maximum.
To rapidly remove exterior frost orice from the windshield (on very colddays), first select the Recirculationmode. Once the windshield is clear,select the Fresh Air mode to avoidfogging the windows.
1.2.3.4.
1.2.
3.
4.
1.2.
3.
CONTINUED
Comfort and Convenience Features
Heating and Cooling
To Heat and Dehumidify with AirConditioning
To Defog and Defrost
125
Information Provided by:
These settings direct all the air flowto the defroster vents at the base ofthe windshield and the side windowdefroster vents. The air flow will getwarmer and clear the windows fasteras the engine warms up. You canclose the corner vents with the dialunderneath each vent. This will sendmore warm air to the windshielddefroster vents.
For safety, make sure you have aclear view through all the windowsbefore driving.
Heating and Cooling
Comfort and Convenience Features126
MODE CONTROL DIAL
TEMPERATURECONTROL DIAL
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
FAN CONTROLDIAL
AIR CONDITIONINGBUTTON
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle also has a rear A/C unitthat allows the rear passengers toadjust the heating, cooling, and fanspeed. See page for operation ofthe rear A/C unit.
To shut off the system temporarily,turn the fan speed and temperaturecontrol dials all the way to the left.
You should shut the systemcompletely off only for the first fewminutes of driving in cold weather,until the engine coolant warms upenough to operate the heater. Keepthe fan on at all other times so staleair does not build up in the interior.
136
Rear A/C Unit To Turn Everything Off
Heating and Cooling
Comfort and Convenience Features 127
Information Provided by:
The automatic climate controlsystem in your Honda picks theproper combination of air condi-tioning, heating, and ventilation tomaintain the interior temperatureyou select. The system also adjuststhe fan speed and air flow levels.
Your vehicle also has a rear A/C unitthat allows the rear passengers toadjust the heating, cooling, and airflow (see page ).
The vents in the corners of thedashboard can be opened and closedwith the dials underneath them.
The direction of air flow from thevents in the center and each cornerof the dashboard is adjustable.Move the tab in the center of eachvent up-and-down and side-to-side.
The climate control system draws airthrough the exterior vents at thebottom of the windshield. Keepthese vents clear of leaves and otherdebris.
For the climate control system toprovide heating and cooling, theengine must be running.
135
On EX model
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
128
CENTER VENTS CORNER VENT
Information Provided by:
Climate Control System
Comfort and Convenience Features 129
REAR CENTER VENT
Information Provided by:
To put the Automatic ClimateControl in fully-automatic mode,press the AUTO button and set thedesired temperature by turning thetemperature control dial. You willsee FULL AUTO in the system’sdisplay. The light above the
button also show you whichmode, Recirculation or Fresh Air, isselected.
The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature from its current level tothe set temperature.
Pressing the OFF button shuts theclimate control system completelyoff. Keep the system completely offonly for short periods. To keep staleair and mustiness from collecting,you should have the fan running atall times.
When you set the temperature to itslower limit (60°F/18°C) or its upperlimit (90°F/32°C), the system runsat full cooling or heating only. It doesnot regulate the interior temperature.
When the temperature is setbetween the lower and upper limits,the system regulates the interiortemperature to the set value.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
Fully-automatic Operation
130
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
FAN CONTROLBUTTONS
OFF BUTTON
AUTO BUTTON TEMPERATURE CONTROL DIAL
MODE BUTTON
AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
Information Provided by:
▲
You can manually select variousfunctions of the Climate Controlsystem when it is in FULL AUTO.All other features remain auto-matically controlled. Making anymanual selection causes the wordFULL to go out.
Press the A/C button to turn the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.
When you turn the A/C off, the sys-tem cannot regulate the inside tem-perature if you set the dial below theoutside temperature. With the A/Con, use the temperature control dialto adjust the temperature of the airflow to a comfortable setting.
This button controls the source ofthe air going into the system. Whenthe indicator above this button is lit,air from the vehicle’s interior is sentthrough the system again (Recircula-tion mode). When the indicator is off,air is brought in from outside thevehicle (Fresh Air mode).
You can, for example, manually putthe system in recirculation modewhen driving through an area ofsmoke or fumes.
You can manually select the fanspeed by pressing the fan controlbuttons. When you press eitherbutton, the fan is taken out ofautomatic mode and starts to run atits lowest speed. Pressing thebutton repeatedly makes the fan runfaster. The fan speed is shown byvertical bars in the display.
CONTINUED
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
Semi-automatic Operation
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button
Recirculation Button Fan Control Buttons
131
Information Provided by:
Use the MODE button to select thevents the air flows from. Some airwill flow from the dashboard cornervents in all modes. Each time youpress the MODE button, the displayshows the mode selected. Press thebutton four times to see all themodes.
The main air flow is dividedbetween the floor vents anddefroster vents at the base of thewindshield.
The main air flow comesfrom the floor vents.
The main air flow is dividedbetween the dashboard vents andthe floor vents.
The main air flow comesfrom the dashboard vents.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
Mode Buttons
132
Information Provided by:
The button directs the mainair flow to the windshield for fasterdefrosting. It also overrides anyMODE selection you may have made.
When you select , the A/Cturns on automatically and thesystem selects Fresh Air mode. Forfaster defrosting, manually set thefan speed to high. You can alsoincrease air flow to the windshield byclosing the side vents in thedashboard.
When you turn off bypressing the button again, thesystem returns to its former settings.
This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).77
Climate Control System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Rear Window Defogger Button
133
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER BUTTON
Information Provided by:
The climate control system has twosensors. A sunlight sensor is locatedin the top of the dashboard and atemperature sensor is next to thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
Sunlight Sensor/TemperatureSensor
134
SUNLIGHT SENSOR
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle has two controls for therear A/C unit. The rear A/C controlbutton is located on the climatecontrol panel, and the rear A/Cpassenger control dial is on the backof the center console.
You can adjust the heating andcooling of the rear A/C unit withthese controls.
On EX modelRear A/C Unit
Climate Control System
Comfort and Convenience Features 135
REAR A/CCONTROL BUTTON
REAR CENTER VENT REAR A/C PASSENGERCONTROL DIAL
Information Provided by:
When the system is in FULL AUTO,the rear A/C passenger control dialcannot be used. The system willcycle on and off automatically tobring the interior to the settemperature.
To enable the rear A/C passengercontrol dial, press the RR A/CManual button on the control panel.The light in the button will come on.
When the rear A/C passengercontrol dial is enabled, the passengerin the second row can use the rearA/C passenger control dial to adjustthe temperature up to 21°F (10°C)higher or lower than the front. Thisis limited by the minimum andmaximum system temperatures.
With the passenger control dial onthe back of the center console, youcan adjust the rear temperatureindependently of the front.
On EX model On EX modelOn LX modelRear A/C Control Button Rear A/C Passenger Control Dial
Comfort and Convenience Features
Climate Control System
136
AUTO BUTTON
REAR A/C CONTROL BUTTON
CONTROL DIAL
Information Provided by:
Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button.Adjust the volume by turning theknob.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.
CONTINUED
On LX model
Audio System
AM/FM/CD Audio System
Operating the Radio
Comfort and Convenience Features 137
Information Provided by:
-
- -You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, AUTOSELECT, and the Preset buttons.
Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.
The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, pressthe SEEK bar on either the or
side, then release it.Depending on which side you press,the system scans upward or down-ward from the current frequency. Itstops when it finds a station with astrong signal.
The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. You will see SCAN inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
TUNE
SEEK SCAN
138
Information Provided by:
-
Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.
Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.
Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.
To store a frequency:
Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properpreset button to tune to it.
The preset frequencies will be lost ifyour car’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.
You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.
Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Preset
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 139
AM/FM BUTTON STEREO INDICATOR
SCAN INDICATOR
SCANBUTTON
AUTOSELECTBUTTON
PWR/VOL KNOB
SEEK/SKIP BAR
PRESET BUTTONS
TUNE/MODE KNOB
Information Provided by:
- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.
If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.
To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will flash inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.
If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.
Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
AUTO SELECT
140
AUTO SELECT INDICATOR SCAN BUTTON
TUNEKNOB
A.SEL BUTTONSEEK BAR
Information Provided by:
-
-
Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob. Each mode is shown inthe display as it changes.
These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.
Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.
Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the desired mode byturning the TUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.
The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.
Adjusting the Sound
Balance/Fader
Treble/Bass
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 141
Adjustment Level
TUNE KNOB
Information Provided by:
The audio system display usuallyshows the time when the ignitionswitch is in ACCESSORY (I) or ON(II). It shows the operation mode ofthe radio, CD player, or optionalcassette player or CD changer whenyou operate them, then goes back tothe time display after five seconds.
You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, pressing andholding the clock button, thenpressing the RESET button (preset6) sets the clock back to the previoushour. If the displayed time is afterthe half hour, the clock is setforward to the beginning of the nexthour.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the timesetting will be lost. To set the timeagain, follow the setting procedure.
For example:1:06 will reset to 1:001:52 will reset to 2:00
To set the clock, press and hold theCLOCK (SCAN/RPT) button.Change the hours by pressing the H(preset 4) button until the numbersadvance to the desired time. Changethe minutes by pressing the M(preset 5) button until the numbersadvance to the desired time.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Digital Clock
142
RESETMH
CLOCK BUTTON
Information Provided by:
You operate the CD player with thesame controls used for the radio.
For information, see page .
With the ignition switch inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II), insertthe disc into the CD slot. Push thedisc in halfway, the drive will pull itin the rest of the way and begin toplay. The number of the track that isplaying is shown in the display.
You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. Playonly standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.
176
73
CONTINUED
Operating the CD Player
Audio System Lighting
Radio Frequencies and Reception
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 143
CD/TAPE BUTTON
AM/FM BUTTON CD SLOT RPT BUTTON
REPEAT INDICATOR
EJECTBUTTON
PWR/VOL KNOB
SEEK/SKIP BAR
RANDOM INDICATOR
A.SEL/RDM BUTTON
Information Provided by:
You can use the SEEK/SKIP barwhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the SEEK/SKIP bar. Pressthe side to move forward. Youwill see CUE in the display. Press the
side to move backward. Youwill see REW displayed. Release thebar when the system reaches thepoint you want.
Press the eject button to remove thedisc from the drive.
If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD button.
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignition,the disc will stay in the drive. Whenyou turn the system back on, the CDwill begin playing where it left off.
You can switch to the radio while aCD is playing by pressing the AM/FM button. Press the CD button toreturn to playing the CD. The CDwill begin playing where it left off.
When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-ning and play that disc again.
Each time you press and release theside of the SEEK/SKIP bar,
the system skips forward to thebeginning of the next track. Pressand release the side to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features144
Information Provided by:
-
-
-+
To activate the Repeatfeature, press and release the RPTbutton. You will see RPT in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current track. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.
A Compact Disc changer is availablefor your car. It holds up to six discs,providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the in-dashCD player.
Load the desired CDs in themagazine and load the magazine inthe changer according to theinstructions that came with the unit.Play only standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
This feature,when activated, plays the tracks onthe CD in random order, rather thanin the order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressand release the A. SEL/RDM button.You will see RDM in the display. Thesystem will then select and playtracks randomly. This continuesuntil you deactivate Random Play bypressing A. SEL/RDM again.
To select the CD changer, press theCD button. The disc and tracknumbers will be displayed.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
To select a different disc, use thePreset 5 (DISC ) or Preset 6(DISC ) button. Press the Preset 6button to select the next disc in themagazine. Press the Preset 5 buttonto select the previous disc. If youselect an empty slot in the magazine,the changer will, after finding thatslot empty, try to load the CD in thenext slot. This continues until it findsa CD to load and play.
CONTINUED
REPEAT Operating the CD Changer(Optional)
RANDOM PLAY
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 145
Information Provided by:
When you switch back to CD mode,the system selects the same unit (in-dash or changer) that was playingwhen you switched out of CD mode.
To use the SKIP, REPEAT, andRANDOM functions, refer to the in-dash player operating instructions.
If you load a CD in the in-dash playerwhile the changer is playing a CD,the system will stop the changer andbegin playing the in-dash CD. Toselect the changer again, press theCD button. Play will begin where itleft off. Use the CD button to switchbetween the player and the changer.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.
If you eject the disc in the in-dashCD while it is playing, the systemwill automatically switch to the CDchanger and begin play where it leftoff. If there are no CDs in thechanger, the display will flash. Youwill have to select another mode(AM or FM) with the button.
185
Protecting Compact Discs
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features146
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDplayer, find the cause in the chart tothe right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the car to yourHonda dealer.
Indication SolutionCause
Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if the disc is inserted correctly in the CDplayer.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the CD cannot be pulled out or the errorindication does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your Honda dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
CD Player Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 147
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDchanger, find the cause in the chartto the right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the car to yourHonda dealer.
Indication SolutionCause
Press the magazine eject button and pull outthe magazine, check for error indication. Insertthe magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Insert CD.
Press the magazine eject button and pull outthe magazine, check for error indication. Insertthe magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Insert CD magazine.
FOCUS Error
No CD in the CDmagazine
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
No CD magazine in theCD changer.
CD Changer Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features148
Information Provided by:
*
*
The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andauto-reverse for continuous play.
To operate the cassette player, theignition switch must be inACCESSORY(I) or ON(II). Makesure the tape opening on the cassetteis facing to the right, then insert thecassette most of the way into the slot.The system will pull it in the rest ofthe way, and begin to play.
2
Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.
CONTINUED
Operating the Cassette Player(Optional)
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 149
AM/FM BUTTON
PWR/VOLKNOB
CD/TAPEBUTTON
REPEATINDICATOR
TAPE DIRECTION INDICATOR
REPEATBUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BAR PLAY/PROGBUTTON
REW BUTTON FF BUTTON
NR BUTTON
Information Provided by:
▲
The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PLAY/PROG button.
Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the NR button.
When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton on the cassette player.
Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.
If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the cassette player will be inpause mode. To begin playing, pressthe PLAY/PROG button.
To switch to the radio or CD playerwhile a tape is playing, press theAM/FM, or CD/TAPE button. Tochange back to the cassette player,press the CD/TAPE button.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features150
Information Provided by:
--With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.
The Skip function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To activate SKIP, pressthe SEEK/SKIP bar. Press the
side to advance to thebeginning of the next song orpassage, or the side to return tothe beginning of the current song orpassage. FF or REW will flash in thedisplay as the tape moves. When thesystem reaches the beginning of thenext song or passage (FF), or thebeginning of the current one (REW),it goes back to PLAY mode.
Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the FF, REW or PLAY/PROGbutton to take the system out of re-wind or fast forward. When the sys-tem reaches the end of the tape, itreverses direction and begins to play.
CONTINUED
Tape Search Functions SKIPFF/REW
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 151
Information Provided by:
- The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.
The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.
Damaged cassettes can jam insidethe drive or cause other problems.See page for information oncassette care and protection.
181
REPEAT Caring for the Cassette Player
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features152
Information Provided by:
*
*
CONTINUED
Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.
The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.
The anti-theft feature will disable thesystem if it is disconnected from thevehicle’s battery. To get the systemworking again, you must enter acode number (see page ).189
2
Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.
On EX model
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
AM/FM/Cassette/CD AudioSystem
153
Information Provided by:
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob. Adjust the volume byturning the same knob.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.
Operating the Radio
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features154
FMBUTTON
AMBUTTON
TUNE KNOB
PRESET BUTTONS
PWR/VOLKNOB
SCANINDICATOR
STEREOINDICATOR
SCAN BUTTON SEEK BUTTONS
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
-
- +
You can use any of four methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN or thePreset buttons.
Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.
You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.
To store a frequency:Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.
Use the TUNE or SEEK functionto tune the radio to a desiredstation.
Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.
Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.
Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properPreset button to tune to it. Thepreset frequencies will be lost if yourvehicle’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.
The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, presseither the or SEEK button,then release it. Depending on whichbutton you press, the system scansupward or downward from thecurrent frequency. It stops when itfinds a station with a strong signal.
The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.
1.
2.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
TUNE
Preset
SEEK
SCAN
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 155
Information Provided by:
- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.
To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will flash inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.
If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.
AUTO SELECT
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features156
A.SELINDICATOR
A.SELBUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
FM BUTTON
AM BUTTON
Information Provided by:
If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.
Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 157
A.SELINDICATOR
TUNE KNOB
SCANBUTTON
A.SELBUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS SEEK BUTTONS
FMBUTTON
AMBUTTON
Information Provided by:
-
-
These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.
Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe MODE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theMODE knob.
Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the MODEknob. Adjust the selected mode byturning the MODE knob. Thedisplayed number shows you thecurrent setting.
Adjusting the Sound
Balance/Fader
Treble/Bass
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features158
ADJUSTMENT LEVEL DIGITAL CLOCK
SETBUTTON
H BUTTON M BUTTONMODE KNOB
Information Provided by:
-
+
The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.
Select BAL or FAD by pressing theMODE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theMODE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.
For information, see page .
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.
The right display shows the timewhen the ignition is in ACCESSORY(I) or ON (II).
To set the clock, press and hold theSET (TUNE) button until thenumbers flash. Change the hours bypressing the H ( ) button until thenumbers advance to the desired time.Change the minutes by pressing theM ( ) button until the numbersadvance to the desired time. Whenyou are finished, press the SETbutton again.
C
73
176
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Audio System Lighting
Radio Frequencies and Reception
Digital Clock
159
Information Provided by:
▲
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).Make sure the tape opening on thecassette is facing to the right, theninsert the cassette most of the wayinto the slot. The system will pull itin the rest of the way, and begin toplay.
Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the button.
The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PROGbutton.
Operating the Cassette Player
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features160
DOLBYINDICATOR
TAPE DIRECTIONINDICATOR
CASSETTESLOT
TAPE EJECTBUTTON
TAPEBUTTON
PROG BUTTON
Information Provided by:
Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.
When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton.
You can remove the cassette withthe ignition switch in any position,even if the audio system is turned off.
If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the tape will begin playingwhere it left off.
To switch to the radio, CD player, orCD changer, press the AM/FM orCD/CHG button. To change back tothe cassette player, press the TAPEbutton.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 161
PWR/VOLKNOB
CASSETTE SLOT
RPTBUTTON
FF BUTTON
TAPEEJECTBUTTON
CD/CHG BUTTON
SKIP BUTTONS
TAPEBUTTON
AMBUTTON
FMBUTTON
REW BUTTON
PLAY/PROG BUTTON
Information Provided by:
-
- +
-
-
-
+
With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.
The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.
Damaged cassettes can jam insidethe drive or cause other problems.See page for information oncassette care and protection.
Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the FF, REW or PLAY/PROGbutton to take the system out of re-wind or fast forward. When the sys-tem reaches the end of the tape, itreverses direction and begins to play.
To stop the SKIP function before itfinds the beginning of a song orpassage, press either SKIP button( or ).
The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.
Pressing the REW or FF button, oreither SKIP button, also turns offREPEAT.
The SKIP function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To skip to the beginningof a song or passage currentlyplaying, push the button. You willsee REW flashing in the display asthe tape rewinds. To skip to thebeginning of the next song, push the
button. You will see FF flashing in
the display as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds the begin-ning of a song or passage, it goesback to PLAY.
181
Tape Search Functions
Caring for the Cassette Player
FF/REW
REPEAT
SKIP
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features162
Information Provided by:
You operate the CD player with thesame controls used for the radio.
With the ignition switch inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II), insertthe disc into the CD slot. Push thedisc in halfway, the drive will pull itin the rest of the way and begin toplay. The number of the track that isplaying is shown in the display.
You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. Playonly standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
CONTINUED
Operating the CD Player
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 163
SEEK/SKIPBUTTONS
CD BUTTONRDMBUTTON
RPTBUTTON
CD EJECTBUTTON
CD SLOTPWR/VOLKNOB
Information Provided by:
-
-+
-
+
-
When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-ning and play that disc again.
You can switch to the radio while aCD is playing by pressing the AM/FM button. Press the CD button toreturn to playing the CD. The CDwill begin playing where it left off.
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignition,the disc will stay in the drive. Whenyou turn the system back on, the CDwill begin playing where it left off.
Press the eject button to remove thedisc from the drive.
If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD button.
To activate the Repeatfeature, press and release the RPTbutton. You will see RPT in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current track. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.
This feature,when activated, plays the tracks onthe CD in random order, rather thanin the order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressand release the A. SEL/RDM button.You will see RDM in the display. Thesystem will then select and playtracks randomly. This continuesuntil you deactivate Random Play bypressing A. SEL/RDM again.
You can use the SEEK/SKIP buttonswhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the SEEK/SKIP button.Press the button to moveforward. You will see CUE in thedisplay. Press the button tomove backward. You will see REWdisplayed. Release the button whenthe system reaches the point youwant.
Each time you press and release theSEEK/SKIP button, the
system skips forward to thebeginning of the next track. Pressand release the button to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
REPEAT
RANDOM PLAY
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features164
Information Provided by:
-+
A Compact Disc changer is availablefor your vehicle. It holds up to sixdiscs, providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the in-dashCD player.
Load the desired CDs in themagazine and load the magazine inthe changer according to theinstructions that came with the unit.Play only standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
To select the CD changer, press theCD button. The disc and tracknumbers will be displayed.
To select a different disc, use thePreset 5 (DISC ) or Preset 6(DISC ) button. Press the Preset 6button to select the next disc in themagazine. Press the Preset 5 buttonto select the previous disc. If youselect an empty slot in the magazine,the changer will, after finding thatslot empty, try to load the CD in thenext slot. This continues until it findsa CD to load and play.
If you load a CD in the in-dash playerwhile the changer is playing a CD,the system will stop the changer andbegin playing the in-dash CD. Toselect the changer again, press theCD button. Play will begin where itleft off. Use the CD button to switchbetween the player and the changer.
If you eject the in-dash CD while it isplaying, the system will automaticallyswitch to the CD changer and beginplay where it left off. If there are noCDs in the changer, the display willflash. You will have to select anothermode (Radio or Cassette Player).
When you switch back to CD mode,the system selects the same unit (in-dash or changer) that was playingwhen you switched out of CD mode.
To use the SKIP, REPEAT, andRANDOM functions, refer to the in-dash player operating instructions.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.185
Operating the CD Changer(Optional)
Protecting Compact Discs
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 165
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDplayer, find the cause in the chart tothe right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the vehicle toyour Honda dealer.
Indication Cause Solution
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error, or aDVD has been loaded inthe CD player
High Temperature
Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if the disc is inserted correctly in the CDplayer.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the CD cannot be pulled out, or the errorindication does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your Honda dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
CD Player Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features166
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDchanger, find the cause in the chartto the right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the vehicle toyour Honda dealer.
Indication Cause Solution
FOCUS Error
No CD in the CDmagazine
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
No CD magazine in theCD changer
Press the magazine eject button, pull out themagazine, and check for an error indication.Insert the magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Insert CD.
Press the magazine eject button, pull out themagazine, and check for an error indication.Insert the magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Insert CD magazine.
CD Changer Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 167
Information Provided by:
*
*
Your Honda’s audio system providesclear reception on both AM and FMbands, while the preset buttons allowyou to easily select your favoritestations.
The cassette system features Dolbynoise reduction, automatic sensing ofchromium-dioxide (CrO ) tape, andautoreverse for continuous play.
The anti-theft feature will disable thesystem if it is disconnected from thevehicle’s battery. To get the systemworking again, you must enter acode number (see page ).189
2
Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.
Optional on U.S. EX model
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
AM/FM/Cassette/CD/DVDAudio system
168
Information Provided by:
This system also has a rearentertainment system that allows therear passengers to listen throughwireless headhones to differentprogramming than the front seatoccupants. A built-in DVD playerallows the rear passengers to watchDVDs or video CDs. To operate thispart of the system, refer to RearEntertainment System on page .
The front control panel has twodisplays. The left display shows theinformation for the front part of thesystem.
When the rear system is on, theright display shows the informationfor the rear part of the system.
190
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 169
FRONT SYSTEM DISPLAY REAR SYSTEM DISPLAY
Information Provided by:
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the audio system. Turn thesystem on by pushing the PWR/VOL knob. Adjust the volume byturning the same knob.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station is broadcast-ing in stereo. Stereo reproduction onAM is not available.
Operating the Radio
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features170
SCANINDICATOR
STEREOINDICATOR
TUNE KNOB
AM/FMBUTTON
SCANBUTTON
PWR/VOLKNOB
PRESET BUTTONS SEEKBUTTONS
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
-
- +
You can use any of four methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN or thePreset buttons.
Use the TUNE knob totune the radio to a desired frequency.Turn the TUNE knob to the right totune to a higher frequency, or to theleft to tune to a lower frequency.Turn the knob right or left until thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.
You can store thefrequencies of your favorite radiostations in the six preset buttons.Each button will store one frequencyon the AM band, and twofrequencies on the FM band.
To store a frequency:Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each Presetbutton.
Use the TUNE or SEEK functionto tune the radio to a desiredstation.
Pick the Preset button you wantfor that station. Press the buttonand hold it until you hear a beep.
Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a totalof six stations on AM and twelveon FM.
Once a station’s frequency is stored,simply press and release the properPreset button to tune to it. Thepreset frequencies will be lost if yourvehicle’s battery goes dead, isdisconnected, or the radio fuse isremoved.
The SEEK functionsearches the band for a station witha strong signal. To activate it, presseither the or SEEK button,then release it. Depending on whichbutton you press, the system scansupward or downward from thecurrent frequency. It stops when itfinds a station with a strong signal.
The SCAN functionsamples all the stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. When the system isin the SCAN mode, SCAN shows inthe display. The system will scan upthe band for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station forapproximately five seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and playthat for five seconds. When it plays astation that you want to continuelistening to, press the SCAN buttonagain.
1.
2.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
TUNE
Preset
SEEK
SCAN
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 171
Information Provided by:
- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive the stations youpreset, you can use the Auto Selectfeature to find stations in the localarea.
To activate Auto Select, press theA. SEL button. A. SEL will flash inthe display, and the system will gointo scan mode for several seconds.It automatically scans both bands,looking for stations with strongsignals. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM stations and twelve FMstations in the preset buttons. Youcan then use the preset buttons toselect those stations.
If you are in a remote area, AutoSelect may not find six strong AMstations or twelve strong FM stations.If this happens, you will see a ‘‘0’’displayed when you press any presetbutton that does not have a stationstored.
AUTO SELECT
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features172
A.SELINDICATOR
AM/FMBUTTON
A.SELBUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
Information Provided by:
If you do not like the stations AutoSelect has stored, you can storeother frequencies in the presetbuttons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN function to find the desiredfrequencies, then store them in theselected preset buttons as describedpreviously.
Auto Select does not erase thefrequencies that you preset pre-viously. When you return home, turnoff Auto Select by pressing theA. SEL button. The preset buttonswill then select the frequencies youoriginally set.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 173
AM/FMBUTTON
A.SELINDICATOR
TUNE KNOB
SCANBUTTON
A.SELBUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS SEEK BUTTONS
Information Provided by:
-
-
Bass, Treble, Balance, and Fader areeach adjustable. You select which ofthese you want to adjust by pressingthe TUNE knob. The mode changesfrom BAS to TRE to FAD to BAL,and then back to the selected audiomode, each time you press theTUNE knob.
Use these modes toadjust the tone to your liking. SelectTRE or BAS by pressing the TUNEknob. Adjust the selected mode byturning the TUNE knob. Thedisplayed number shows you thecurrent setting.
These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,while FAD adjusts the front-to-backstrength.
Adjusting the Sound
Treble/Bass
Balance/Fader
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features174
DIGITAL CLOCK
SETBUTTON
TUNE KNOB
ADJUSTMENT LEVEL
Information Provided by:
-
+
Select BAL or FAD by pressing theTUNE knob. Adjust the Balance orFader to your liking by turning theTUNE knob.The displayed number shows youthe current setting.When the adjustment level reachesthe center, you will see ‘‘ ’’.
The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about five seconds after youstop adjusting a mode with theTUNE knob.
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.
The right display usually shows thetime when the ignition is inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II). Itshows the operation mode of theradio, cassette player, CD player, orrear entertainment system when youoperate them, then goes back to thetime display after five seconds.
To set the clock, press and hold theSET (TUNE) button until thenumbers flash. Change the hours bypressing the H ( ) button until thenumbers advance to the desired time.Change the minutes by pressing theM ( ) button until the numbersadvance to the desired time. Whenyou are finished, press the SETbutton again.
C
73
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Audio System LightingDigital Clock
175
Information Provided by:
Your Honda’s radio can receive thecomplete AM and FM bands.Those bands cover these frequen-cies:
AM band:530 to 1,710 kilohertzFM band:87.7 to 107.9 megahertz
Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least tenkilohertz apart (530, 540, 550).Stations on the FM band areassigned frequencies at least 0.2megahertz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).
Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’
A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.
How well your Honda’s radioreceives stations is dependent onmany factors, such as the distancefrom the station’s transmitter,nearby large objects, and atmos-pheric conditions.
Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Radio Frequencies Radio Reception
176
Information Provided by:
Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.
Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 177
Information Provided by:
▲
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II).Make sure the tape opening on thecassette is facing to the right, theninsert the cassette most of the wayinto the slot. The system will pull itin the rest of the way, and begin toplay.
Dolby noise reduction turns on whenyou insert a cassette. The indi-cator will light in the display. If thetape was not recorded with Dolbynoise reduction, turn it off bypressing the button.
The tape direction indicator will lightto show you which side of thecassette is playing. The indicatesthe side you inserted facing upwardis now playing. If you want to playthe other side, press the PROGbutton.
Operating the Cassette Player
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features178
DOLBYINDICATOR
TAPE DIRECTIONINDICATOR
CASSETTESLOT
TAPE EJECTBUTTON
PWR/VOLKNOB
PROG BUTTON
TAPEBUTTON
Information Provided by:
Noise reduction remains off until youturn it on by pressing the buttonagain.
When the system reaches the end ofthe tape, it will automatically reversedirection and play the other side. Ifyou want to remove the cassettefrom the drive, press the EJECTbutton.
You can remove the cassette withthe ignition switch in any position,even if the audio system is turned off.
If you turn the system off while atape is playing, either with the PWR/VOL knob or by turning off theignition, the cassette will remain inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the tape will begin playingwhere it left off.
To switch to the radio, CD player, orCD changer, press the AM/FM orCD/CHG button. To change back tothe cassette player, press the TAPEbutton.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 179
PWR/VOLKNOB
AM/FMBUTTON
CASSETTE SLOT
TAPEEJECTBUTTONRPT
BUTTON
REWBUTTON
PLAY/PROG BUTTON
FF BUTTON
CD/CHG BUTTON
SEEK BUTTONS
Information Provided by:
-
- +
-
-
-
+
With a cassette playing, you can usethe FF, REW, SKIP, or REPEATfunction to find a desired program.
The SKIP and REPEAT functionsuse silent periods on the tape to findthe end of a song or passage. Thesefeatures may not work to yoursatisfaction if there is almost no gapbetween selections, a high noiselevel between selections, or a silentperiod in the middle of a selection.
Fast Forward and Re-wind move the tape rapidly. To re-wind the tape, push the REW button.You will see REW in the display. Tofast forward the tape, push the FFbutton. You will see FF displayed.Press the FF, REW or PLAY/PROGbutton to take the system out of re-wind or fast forward. When the sys-tem reaches the end of the tape, itreverses direction and begins to play.
To stop the SKIP function before itfinds the beginning of a song orpassage, press either SKIP button( or ).
The Repeat functioncontinuously replays the currentsong or passage. Press the RPTbutton to activate it; you will see RPTdisplayed as a reminder. When thesystem reaches the end of the songor passage currently playing, it willautomatically go into rewind. Whenit senses the beginning of the samesong or passage, the system returnsto PLAY mode. It will continue torepeat this same program until youdeactivate REPEAT by pressing thebutton again.
Pressing the REW or FF button, oreither SKIP button, also turns offREPEAT.
The SKIP function allowsyou to find the beginning of a songor passage. To skip to the beginningof a song or passage currentlyplaying, push the button. You willsee REW flashing in the display asthe tape rewinds. To skip to thebeginning of the next song, push the
button. You will see FF flashing in
the display as the tape fast forwards.When the system finds the begin-ning of a song or passage, it goesback to PLAY.
Tape Search Functions
FF/REW
REPEAT
SKIP
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features180
Information Provided by:
The cassette player picks up dirt andoxides from the tape. This contami-nation builds up over time andcauses the sound quality to degrade.To prevent this, you should clean theplayer after every 30 hours of use.Your dealer has a cleaning kitavailable.
If you do not clean the cassetteplayer regularly, it may eventuallybecome impossible to remove thecontamination with a normalcleaning kit.
Use 100-minute or shorter cassettes.Cassettes longer than that usethinner tape that may break or jamthe drive.
Look at the cassette before youinsert it. If the tape is loose, tightenit by turning a hub with a pencil oryour finger.
When they are not in use, storecassettes in their cases to protectthem from dust and moisture. Neverplace cassettes where they will beexposed to direct sunlight, high heat,or high humidity. If a cassette isexposed to extreme heat or cold, letit reach a moderate temperaturebefore inserting it in the player.
Never try to insert foreign objectsinto the cassette player.
If the label is peeling off, remove itfrom the cassette or it could causethe cassette to jam in the player.Never try to insert a warped ordamaged cassette in the player.
Caring for the Cassette Player
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 181
Information Provided by:
You operate the CD player with thesame controls used for the radio.
With the ignition switch inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II), insertthe disc into the CD slot. Push thedisc in halfway, the drive will pull itin the rest of the way and begin toplay. The number of the track that isplaying is shown in the display.
You can also play 3-inch (8-cm) discswithout using an adapter ring. Playonly standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
Comfort and Convenience Features
Operating the CD Player
Audio System
182
PWR/VOLKNOB
CD SLOT CD EJECTBUTTON
RPTBUTTON
RDMBUTTON
CD BUTTON SKIP BUTTONS
Information Provided by:
-
-+
-
+
-
When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will return to the begin-ning and play that disc again.
You can switch to the radio while aCD is playing by pressing the AM/FM button. Press the CD button toreturn to playing the CD. The CDwill begin playing where it left off.
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignition,the disc will stay in the drive. Whenyou turn the system back on, the CDwill begin playing where it left off.
Press the eject button to remove thedisc from the drive.
If you eject the disc, but do notremove it from the slot, the systemwill automatically reload the discafter 15 seconds and put the CDplayer in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the CD button.
To activate the Repeatfeature, press and release the RPTbutton. You will see RPT in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current track. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.
This feature,when activated, plays the tracks onthe CD in random order, rather thanin the order they are recorded on theCD. To activate Random Play, pressand release the A. SEL/RDM button.You will see RDM in the display. Thesystem will then select and playtracks randomly. This continuesuntil you deactivate Random Play bypressing A. SEL/RDM again.
You can use the SEEK/SKIP buttonswhile a disc is playing to selectpassages and change tracks.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the SEEK/SKIP button.Press the button to moveforward. You will see CUE in thedisplay. Press the button tomove backward. You will see REWdisplayed. Release the button whenthe system reaches the point youwant.
Each time you press and release theSEEK/SKIP button, the
system skips forward to thebeginning of the next track. Pressand release the button to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
REPEAT
RANDOM PLAY
183
Information Provided by:
-+
A Compact Disc changer is availablefor your vehicle. It holds up to sixdiscs, providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the in-dashCD player.
Load the desired CDs in themagazine and load the magazine inthe changer according to theinstructions that came with the unit.Play only standard round discs. Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the drive orcause other problems.
For best results when using CD-Rdiscs, use only high quality discslabeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R, the recordingmust be closed in order for the discto be used by CD players. CD-RWdiscs will not work in this unit.
To select the CD changer, press theCD button. The disc and tracknumbers will be displayed.
To select a different disc, use thePreset 5 (DISC ) or Preset 6(DISC ) button. Press the Preset 6button to select the next disc in themagazine. Press the Preset 5 buttonto select the previous disc. If youselect an empty slot in the magazine,the changer will, after finding thatslot empty, try to load the CD in thenext slot. This continues until it findsa CD to load and play.
If you load a CD in the in-dash playerwhile the changer is playing a CD,the system will stop the changer andbegin playing the in-dash CD. Toselect the changer again, press theCD button. Play will begin where itleft off. Use the CD button to switchbetween the player and the changer.
If you eject the in-dash CD while it isplaying, the system will automaticallyswitch to the CD changer and beginplay where it left off. If there are noCDs in the changer, the display willflash. You will have to select anothermode (Radio or Cassette Player).
When you switch back to CD mode,the system selects the same unit (in-dash or changer) that was playingwhen you switched out of CD mode.
To use the SKIP, REPEAT, andRANDOM functions, refer to the in-dash player operating instructions.
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features
Operating the CD Changer(Optional)
184
Information Provided by:
Never try to insert foreign objects inthe CD player or the magazine.
A new CD may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on the re-cording surface of the disc, causingskipping or other problems. Removethese pieces by rubbing the innerand outer edges with the side of apencil or pen.
Handle a CD by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the CD.These, along with contaminationfrom fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tippens, can cause the CD to not playproperly, or possibly jam in the drive.
When a CD is not being played, storeit in its case to protect it from dustand other contamination. To preventwarpage, keep CDs out of directsunlight and extreme heat.
To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the disc from the centerto the outside edge.
Protecting Compact Discs
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 185
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDplayer, find the cause in the chart tothe right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the vehicle toyour Honda dealer.
Indication SolutionCause
Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if the disc is inserted correctly in the CDplayer.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the CD cannot be pulled out, or the errorindication does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your Honda dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error, or aDVD has been loaded inthe CD player
High Temperature
CD Player Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features186
Information Provided by:
If you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the CDchanger, find the cause in the chartto the right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the vehicle toyour Honda dealer.
Indication Cause Solution
FOCUS Error
No CD in the CDmagazine
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
No CD magazine in theCD changer
Press the magazine eject button, pull out themagazine, and check for an error indication.Insert the magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Insert CD.
Press the magazine eject button, pull out themagazine, and check for an error indication.Insert the magazine again. If the code does notdisappear or the magazine cannot be pulled out,consult your Honda dealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Insert CD magazine.
CD Changer Error Indications
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 187
Information Provided by:
▲ ▼
Three controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. These let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the wheel.
The middle button adjusts thevolume up ( ) or down ( ). Pressthe top or bottom of the button andhold it until the desired volume isreached, then release it.
The CH button has three functions,depending on whether you arelistening to the radio, or playing acassette or CD.
If you are listening to the radio, usethe CH button to change stations.Each time you press this button, thesystem advances to the next presetstation on the band you are listeningto. You will see the number of theselected Preset button in the display.To change bands, or change fromFM1 to FM2, press the AM/FMbutton.
If you are playing a cassette, use theCH button to advance to the nextselection. You will see ‘‘FF’’ blinkingin the display when you press the CHbutton. The system fast forwardsuntil it senses a silent period, thengoes back to PLAY.
If you are playing a CD, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack each time you push the CHbutton. You will see the disc andtrack number in the display.
Remote Audio Controls
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features188
CH BUTTON
AM/FMBUTTON
VOLUMEBUTTON
Information Provided by:
You will have to store your favoritestations in the Preset buttons afterthe system begins working. Youroriginal settings were lost whenpower was disconnected.
If your vehicle’s battery is discon-nected or goes dead, the audiosystem will disable itself. If thishappens, you will see ‘‘Code’’ in thefrequency display the next time youturn on the system. Use the Presetbuttons to enter the five-digit code. Ifit is entered correctly, the radio willstart playing.
If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over or try tocorrect your mistake. Complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have ten tries toenter the correct code. If you areunsuccessful in ten attempts, youmust then leave the system on forone hour before trying again.
Your vehicle’s audio system willdisable itself if it is disconnectedfrom electrical power for any reason.To make it work again, the usermust enter a specific five-digit codein the Preset buttons. Because thereare hundreds of numbercombinations possible from fivedigits, making the system workwithout knowing the exact code isnearly impossible.
You should have received a card thatlists your audio system’s codenumber and serial number. It is bestto store this card in a safe place athome. In addition, you should writethe audio system’s serial number inthis Owner’s Manual. If you shouldhappen to lose the card, you mustobtain the code number from yourHonda dealer. To do this, you willneed the system’s serial number.
On EX modelTheft Protection
Audio System
Comfort and Convenience Features 189
Information Provided by:
Your Honda is equipped with a RearEntertainment System that includesa DVD player for the enjoyment ofthe rear passengers. With thissystem, the rear passengers canenjoy a different entertainmentsource (radio, cassette player, CDplayer or DVD player) than the frontseat occupants.
The ignition switch must be inACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) tooperate the Rear EntertainmentSystem.
Turn on the rear system by pressingthe REAR PWR button. The rearentertainment system can then beoperated from the front control panel,the rear control panel on the ceiling,or with the remote control. The rightdisplay then shows the informationfor the rear system.
Optional on EX model
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features190
REAR PWRBUTTON
Information Provided by:
When the rear system is turned on, itselects the entertainment source itwas last set to. If that source hasbeen removed (the DVD has beenejected from the player, for example),you will see ‘‘_ _ _ _’’ in the display.You must select another source.
When you turn on the rear system,the rear speakers are automaticallyturned off. You will see the RearSpeakers Off icon in the right display.The sound for the rear system issent to the wireless headphones. Ifyou want to turn the rear speakerson again, press and hold the REARPWR button until they come on.
NOTE: The rear speakers areconnected to the front system, sothey will always play the source thatthe front system is set to. Forexample, if you are listening to theradio, and your rear passengers arelistening to a CD through theheadphones, the rear speakers will
play the radio when you turn themon. To have the vehicle speakersplay the CD, change the front sourcefrom AM/FM to CD.
Pressing the RR CTRL selector knobturns off the rear controls. Your
passengers are not able to operatethe rear system with the controlpanel in the ceiling or with theremote control. You will see the RearControls Off icon in the right display.Press the selector knob again to turnthe rear controls back on.
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 191
REAR PWRBUTTON
RR CTRLSELECTOR KNOB
REAR CONTROLSOFF ICON
REAR SPEAKERSOFF ICON
Information Provided by:
*
*
The DVD player in your RearEntertainment System can play DVDvideo discs and CDs. It featuresDolby noise reduction. The videoscreen is designed for use by therear seat passengers only.The driver and front seat passengershould not try to view the screenwhile driving.
Open the overhead screen bypushing on the button. The screenwill swing down part-way. Pivot thescreen the rest of the way. If youpivot the screen too far forward, pastthe detent, the display will turn off.Pivot the screen back to the detentto turn the display back on. To closethe screen, pivot it up until it latches.
The DVD player is located under thefront control panel. Insert the discinto the DVD slot. Push the disc inhalfway, the drive will pull it in therest of the way.Press the eject button to remove thedisc from the drive.
Follow the instructions on thefollowing pages to operate the DVDplayer from the front control panel,the rear control panel, or with theremote control.
Dolby noise reduction manufactured underlicense from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corpo-ration. ‘‘DOLBY’’ and the double-D symbol
are trademarks of Dolby LaboratoriesLicensing Corporation.
Rear Video Operation
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features192
REAR CONTROLPANEL
BUTTON
OVERHEADSCREEN
EJECTBUTTON
DVD SLOT
Information Provided by:
To return front panel control to thefront audio system, turn the knobcounterclockwise. The system willautomatically change back to thefront system several seconds afteryou stop pressing the buttons.
To operate the rear entertainmentsystem from the front panel, youmust first turn the RR CTRL knobclockwise to enable the panel. Theamber RR LED will come on to showthat the control panel is now enabled.
CONTINUED
Operating the DVD Player fromthe Front Control Panel
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 193
REAR PWRBUTTON
RR CTRL SELECTORKNOB
RR LED
RPTBUTTON
PLAYBUTTON
PAUSEBUTTON
SEEK/SKIPBAR
RDMBUTTON
Information Provided by:
+
-
+
-
-
Some DVDs start playingautomatically after the disc is loadedcompletely. If a disc does not startplaying, press the PLAY button. Ifthe system is in PAUSE mode, pressthe PLAY button to cancel thePAUSE mode.
Press the PAUSE button to pausethe disc. Press the button again orpress the PLAY button to return toPLAY. PAUSE works only withDVDs.
Press the RPT button tocontinuously replay the current track.You will see RPT in the display.Press the button again to turn it off.RPT works only with CDs.
To play the tracks within a CD inrandom order, press the RDMbutton. You will see RDM in thedisplay. Press the button again tocancel RDM. RDM works only withCDs.
You can move rapidly within a trackor a chapter by pressing the SEEK/SKIP buttons. Press and hold thebutton to move forward, You will see‘‘CUE’’ in the display. Press and holdthe side to move backward, Youwill see ‘‘REV’’ in the display.Release the button when the systemreaches the point you want.
Each time you press and release thebutton, the system skips forward
to the beginning of the next track orchapter. Press and release thebutton to skip backward to thebeginning of the current track orchapter. If you press the buttonwhile the beginning of a track orchapter is playing, the system skipsto the beginning of the previoustrack or chapter.
PLAY Button
PAUSE Button
RPT Button
RDM Button
SEEK/SKIP Buttons
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features194
Information Provided by:
▲ ▼
You can control some DVD functionsfrom the rear control panel in theceiling Make sure the rear controloperation has not been disabled withthe RR CTRL knob on the frontpanel.
Use these buttons to select theentertainment source (radio,cassette player, CD player/CDchanger, or DVD player/Auxiliarydevice). The selected source will beshown in the display.
Press this button when you want topause a DVD. Press this buttonagain to go back to Play. To select the menu on the DVD,
press the MENU button. Use the, , , and buttons to
move to the desired menu selection,then press the ENT button to enteryour selection.
Press the button to skip to thebeginning of the next chapter. Pressthe button to skip back to the
beginning of the current chapter.If you press the button while thebeginning of a chapter is playing, thesystem skips to the beginning of theprevious chapter.
Operating the DVD Player fromthe Rear Control Panel
Source Selection Buttons
PLAY/PAUSE/PROG Button
MENU/ENT Buttons
SEEK/SKIP Buttons
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 195
SOURCE SELECTIONBUTTONS
REAR CONTROLSOFF BUTTON
MENUBUTTON
SEEK/SKIPBUTTON
CH/DISKBUTTON
SEEK/SKIPBUTTON
CH/DISKBUTTON
ENT BUTTONPLAY/PAUSE/PROGBUTTON
Information Provided by:
You can control all of the DVDfunctions with the remote control.Make sure the rear control operationhas not been disabled with the RRCTRL knob on the front panel.
When using the remote control,point it at the rear control panel inthe ceiling.
Press this button to start playing aDVD.
Use these buttons to select theentertainment source (radio,cassette player, CD player/CDchanger, or DVD player/Auxiliarydevice). The selected source will beshown in the display.
Operating the DVD Player withthe Remote Control
Source Selection Buttons
PLAY/PROG Button
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features196
SOURCE SELECTIONBUTTONS
REW/FWD BUTTONS
STOP BUTTON
PAUSE BUTTON
PLAY/PROG BUTTON
MENU BUTTON
SUBTITLE BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
ANGLE BUTTON
TITLE BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP BUTTONS
DISP BUTTON
RETURN (T/C) BUTTON
Information Provided by:
Press this button when you want topause a DVD. Press this buttonagain to go back to Play.
Some DVDs have menus that allowyou to select a dubbed language,subtitles, a chapter list, previews, etc.The menu contents will vary fromDVD to DVD.
Press the MENU button to displaythe DVD’s main menu. Use the ,
, , and buttons to selectthe desired menu option. Then pressENT to enter your selection.
If the menu has more than one page,use the and buttonsto change pages.
You can also use the numberedbuttons to enter the number of amenu option. You do not have topress ENT, the option will beselected when you complete thenumber. Make sure you enter twodigits. If the option number is lessthan 10, enter a ‘‘0’’ first.
Some DVDs have a title menu. Thecontents of the menu vary fromDVD to DVD.
Press the TITLE button to displaythe title menu window. Move yourselection by pressing the , ,
and buttons. Enter yourselection by pressing the ENTbutton. If the menu has more thanone page, use the and
buttons to change pages.Press the TITLE button again toclose the window.
Many DVDs are recorded withsubtitles, sometimes in multiplelanguages. To select subtitles, pressthe SUBTITLE button. Continue topress and release the SUBTITLEbutton to scan through the availablelanguages.
Press this button to stop playing aDVD.
Press the button to skip to thebeginning of the next chapter. Pressthe button to skip back to thebeginning of the current chapter.
Press the button to moveforward rapidly within a chapter. Youwill see CUE in the display. Press the
button to move backwardrapidly within a chapter. You will seeREV in the display. Release thebutton when the system reaches thepoint you want.
PAUSE Button MENU Button TITLE Button
SUBTITLE Button
STOP Button
SKIP Buttons
FWD/REW Buttons
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 197
Information Provided by:
Many DVDs are recorded, ordubbed, in more than one language.To select a different language thanthe one being heard, press theAUDIO button. Continue to pressand release the AUDIO button tohear all the available languages.
To change the color, contrast, aspectratio, and brightness of the videoscreen, press the DISP button. Thecurrent setting of one will bedisplayed on the screen each timeyou press the button. Use the
and buttons to change thesetting as desired. The display willdisappear from the screen severalseconds after you stop adjusting thesetting.
On some DVDs, the scenes arerecorded by more than one camera,giving different viewpoints of thesame scene. By pressing the Anglebutton, you can select a differentviewpoint.
In the MENU selection mode,pressing the RETURN button forless than two seconds changes theMENU display to the previous page.Pressing the RETURN button formore than two seconds while a DVDis playing brings the system into theTITLE enter mode. When you enteryour selection, the DVD player willstart playing from the selected title.
AUDIO Button
DISP Button
ANGLE Button
RETURN (T/C) Button
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features198
Information Provided by:
The tips on how to handle andprotect DVDs are basically the sameas those for compact discs. Refer to‘‘Protecting Compact Discs’’ on page
.
There are various types of DVDsavailable. Some of them are notcompatible with your system.
The DVD player in your RearEntertainment System can play DVDvideo discs and CDs bearing theabove marks on their packages orjackets.
Those packages or jackets shouldalso bear the area designation of ‘‘1’’or ‘‘ALL’’.
DVD-ROMs cannot be played in thissystem.
185
Protecting DVDsPlayable DVDs
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 199
Information Provided by:
Indication SolutionIf you see an error indication in thedisplay while operating the DVDplayer, find the cause in the chart tothe right. If you cannot clear theerror indication, take the vehicle toyour Honda dealer.
Cause
Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if the disc is inserted correctly in theDVD Player.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the DVD cannot be pulled out or the errorindication does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your Honda dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.Run the engine to recharge the battery.
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
Low Vehicle BatteryVoltage
DVD Player Error Indications
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features200
Information Provided by:
▲ ▼
An audio CD can be played in eitherthe main CD player in the front panel,in the DVD/CD player below thefront panel, or in the optional CDchanger. This allows the front andrear passengers to listen to differentCDs.
Select the rear system by turning theRR CTRL knob clockwise. If the CDis loaded in the main CD player, orCD changer, select CD/CHG. If theCD is loaded in the lower player,select DVD/AUX.
If the CD is loaded in the main CDplayer or CD changer, refer to pages
and for operatinginstructions. If the CD is loaded inthe DVD/AUX player, refer to page
.
If the CD is loaded in the main CDplayer or optional CD changer, selectit by pressing the CD/CHG button.If it is loaded in the lower player,press DVD/AUX.
Press the button to skip to thebeginning of the next track. Pressthe button to return to thebeginning of current track. Press itagain to go to the beginning of theprevious track.
If the CD changer is selected, usethe and buttons to changediscs.
If the CD is loaded in the main CDplayer or optional CD changer, selectit by pressing the CD/CHG button.If it is loaded in the lower player,press DVD/AUX.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold either the FWD or REWbuttons. When you press FWD, youwill see ‘‘CUE’’ in the display. Whenyou press REW, you will see ‘‘REW’’in the display. Release the buttonwhen the system reaches the desiredpoint.
Press the button to skip to thebeginning of the next track. Pressthe button to return to thebeginning of the current track. Pressit again to go to the beginning of theprevious track.
182 184
193
Playing a CD With the RearEntertainment System
Playing a CD With the Front Panel
Playing a CD With the Rear ControlPanel
Playing a CD With the RemoteControl
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 201
Information Provided by:
▲▼
Select the radio with the AM/FMbutton on the front panel, the rearcontrol panel, or the remote control.
From the front panel, after selectingthe rear system with the RR CTRLknob, use the TUNE, SEEK, orSCAN functions or the Presetbuttons to select a station.
From the rear control panel in theceiling, use the and
buttons to select the stationsthat are set into the Preset buttons.Pressing the or button willcause the system to search up ordown the band for a station with astrong signal. You will see SEEK inthe display.
To change Preset stations with theremote control, press the or
button. To search for strongstations, press the or
button.
After loading the cassette, select thecassette player with the TAPEbutton on the front panel, the rearcontrol panel, or the remote control.
On the rear control panel, use thePROG/PLAY button to reverse thetape’s direction. Use the and
buttons to skip. Press thebutton to skip forward to the
beginning of the next song orpassage. You will see FF flashing inthe display. Press the button toskip backward to the beginning ofthe current song or passage. You willsee REV flashing in the display.
On the remote control, use thePROG/PLAY button to reverse thetape’s direction. Press the FWD orREW button to fast forward orrewind the tape. Press either ofthose buttons or the PROG/PLAYbutton to return to playing the tape.To skip to the beginning of the nextsong or passage, press the
button. You will see FFflashing in the display. To skip to thebeginning of the current song orpassage, press the button. Youwill see REV flashing in the display.
To operate the cassette player fromthe front panel, refer to page .Make sure you have selected therear system with the RR CTRL knobfirst.
178
Playing the Radio With the RearEntertainment System
Playing a Cassette With the RearEntertainment System
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features202
Information Provided by:
▲
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
To replace the batteries in theremote control, press down on the
symbol on the back, then slide thecover off. Remove the old batteries.Make sure the polarity of newbatteries is correct when you installthem. Install the cover by sliding iton until it locks. The remote controluses two AA batteries.
When you are not using the remotecontrol, store it in its holder in thefront seat pocket as shown.
Replacing Remote ControlBatteries
Storing the Remote Control
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 203
BATTERIES
COVER
HOLDER
Information Provided by:
The batteries are under the domedcovers on the back of each earpiece.To remove a cover, press down on itwith your thumb, slide it backward(away from the headband), then liftit up. Remove the battery and noteits polarity. Install the new battery inthe earpiece with the polarity thesame. Set the cover in place, thenslide it up until it locks. Eachheadphone uses two AAA batteries.
The audio for the rear entertainmentsystem is sent to the wirelessheadphones that come with thesystem. To turn on the headphones,press the red button on the earpiece.Adjust the volume level with the dialat the bottom of the same earpiece.
To adjust the comfort of theheadphones, slide the earpieces upor down the headband.
For greater battery life, turn off theheadphones when they are not in useby pressing the red button again.They will turn off automatically ifthey do not receive an audio signalfrom the system for several minutes.When not in use, store theheadphones in the pocket on theback of either front seat.
Some state and local govermentagencies prohibit the use ofheadphones by the driver of a motorvehicle. Always obey applicable lawsand regulations.
Wireless Headphones Replacing Batteries
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features204
ON/OFF BUTTONVOLUMEDIAL BATTERY
COVER
Information Provided by:
There are three headphoneconnectors for the third seatpassengers. Each connector has itsown volume control.
The system will accept auxiliaryinputs from standard video gamesand video equipment.
Auxiliary input jacks and headphoneconnectors for the rearentertainment system are on theback of the center consolecompartment.
Auxiliary Input Jacks
Rear Entertainment System
Comfort and Convenience Features 205
AUXILIARY INPUT JACKS
HEADPHONE CONNECTORS
VOLUME DIALS
Information Provided by:
Once the security system is set,opening any door (without using thekey or the remote transmitter), orthe hood, will cause it to alarm. Italso alarms if the radio is removedfrom the dashboard or the wiring iscut.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.
The security system will not set ifthe hood, tailgate, or any door is notfully closed. If the system will not set,check the Door and Tailgate OpenMonitor on the instrument panel(see page ) to see if the doors andtailgate are fully closed. Since it isnot part of the monitor display,manually check the hood.
The security system helps to protectyour vehicle and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights, and taillights flash ifsomeone attempts to break into yourvehicle or remove the radio. Thisalarm continues for two minutes,then the system resets. To reset analarming system before the twominutes have elapsed, unlock thedriver’s front door with the key orthe remote transmitter.
The security system sets auto-matically, fifteen seconds after youlock the doors, hood, and tailgate.For the system to activate, you mustlock the doors from the outside withthe key, or remote transmitter. Thesecurity system light next to the lowoil pressure indicator starts blinkingimmediately to show you the systemis setting itself.
64
On EX model
Security System
Comfort and Convenience Features206
SECURITY SYSTEM LIGHT
Information Provided by:
Push in the Cruise Control MasterSwitch to the left of the steeringcolumn. The indicator in theswitch will light.
Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forconditions such as city driving,winding roads, slippery roads, heavyrain, or bad weather. You shouldhave full control of the vehicle underthose conditions.
Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE CONTROLlight on the instrument panelcomes on to show the system isnow activated.
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Cruise Control Using the Cruise Control
Cruise Control
Comfort and Convenience Features 207
CRUISE CONTROL MASTER SWITCH RESUME/ACCEL
CANCEL
SET/DECEL
Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.
Information Provided by:
You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:You can increase the set cruising
speed in any of these ways:
When climbing a steep hill, theautomatic transmission maydownshift to hold the set speed.
The cruise control may not hold theset speed when you are going up anddown hills. If your speed increasesgoing down a hill, use the brakes toslow down to the desired speed. Thiswill cancel the cruise control. Toresume the set speed, press theRESUME/ACCEL button. TheCRUISE CONTROL light on theinstrument panel comes on.
Press and hold the RESUME/ACCEL button. The vehicle willaccelerate. When you reach thedesired cruising speed, release thebutton.
Push on the accelerator pedal.Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed and press the SET/DECELbutton.
To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RESUME/ACCEL button repeatedly. Eachtime you do this, your vehicle willspeed up about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. The vehicle will decelerate.Release the button when youreach the desired speed.
To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/DECELbutton repeatedly. Each time youdo this, your vehicle will slowdown about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL light on the instru-ment panel will go out. When thevehicle slows to the desired speed,press the SET/DECEL button.The vehicle will then maintain thedesired speed.
Changing the Set Speed
Cruise Control
Comfort and Convenience Features208
Information Provided by:
You can cancel the cruise control inany of these ways:
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
Press the Cruise Control MasterSwitch.
Even with the cruise control turnedon, you can still use the acceleratorpedal to speed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The vehiclewill return to the set cruising speed.
Resting your foot on the brake pedalwill cause the cruise control tocancel.
Tap the brake pedal.Pressing the Cruise Control MasterSwitch turns the system completelyoff and erases the previous cruisingspeed from memory. To use thesystem again, refer to
.
When you push the CANCEL button,or tap the brake pedal, the CRUISECONTROL light on the instrumentpanel will go out and the vehicle willbegin to slow down. You can use theaccelerator pedal in the normal way.The system remembers thepreviously-set cruising speed. Toreturn to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h) and thenpress and release the RESUME/ACCEL button. The CRUISECONTROL light comes on. Thevehicle will accelerate to the samecruising speed as before.
Cancelling the Cruise Control
Using theCruise Control
Cruise Control
Comfort and Convenience Features 209
CANCELBUTTON
Information Provided by:
Always refer to the operatinginstructions and safety informationthat came with your garage dooropener or other equipment youintend to operate with the HomeLinkUniversal Transceiver. If you do nothave this information, you shouldcontact the manufacturer of theequipment.
While training or using HomeLink,make sure you have a clear view ofthe garage door or gate, and that noone will be injured by its movement.
The HomeLink transceiver storesthe code in a permanent memory.There should be no need to retrainHomeLink if your car’s battery goesdead or is disconnected.
If your garage door opener wasmanufactured before April 1982, youmay not be able to programHomeLink to operate it. Garage dooropeners manufactured before thatdate do not have a safety feature thatcauses them to stop and reverse if anobstacle is detected during closing,increasing the risk of injury. If youhave questions, call (800) 355-3515.
If you are training HomeLink tooperate a garage door or gate, it isrecommended that you unplug themotor for that device during training.Repeatedly pressing the remotecontrol button could burn out themotor.
The HomeLink UniversalTransceiver built into your vehiclecan be programmed to operateremotely-controlled devices aroundyour home, such as garage doors,lighting, or home security systems. Itcan replace up to three remotetransmitters.
If you have problems with trainingthe HomeLink Universal Transceiver,or would like information on homeproducts that can be operated by thetransmitter, call (800) 355-3515. Onthe Internet, go to www.homelink.com.
On EX model Important Safety Precautions
General Information
Customer Assistance
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Comfort and Convenience Features210
Information Provided by:
-
If you are training the second orthird buttons, go directly to Step 1.
Unplug the garage door openermotor from the house current.
Before you can use HomeLink tooperate devices around your home, itmust ‘‘learn’’ the proper codes. Forexample, to train HomeLink to openand close the garage door:
If you just tookdelivery of your vehicle and have nottrained any of the buttons inHomeLink before, you should eraseany previously learned codes beforetraining the first button. To do this,press and hold the two outsidebuttons on the HomeLinktransceiver for about 20 seconds,until the red light flashes. Releasethe buttons, then proceed to Step 1.
Hold the end of the garage dooropener remote control 2 to 5inches from HomeLink. Makesure you are not blocking yourview of the red light in HomeLink.
Select the HomeLink button youwant to train.
Press the button on the remotecontrol and the button onHomeLink at the same time. Holddown both buttons.
2.
3.
4.1.
CONTINUED
Training HomeLink Before you begin
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Comfort and Convenience Features 211
Information Provided by:
Canadian Owners:The remote control you are trainingfrom may stop transmitting after twoseconds. This is not long enough forHomeLink to learn the code. Releaseand press the button on the remotecontrol every two seconds untilHomeLink has learned the code.
For security purposes, newer garagedoor opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’or variable code. Information fromthe remote control and the garagedoor opener are needed beforeHomeLink can operate the garagedoor opener.
The ‘‘Training HomeLink’’procedure trains HomeLink to theproper garage door opener code.The following proceduresynchronizes HomeLink to thegarage door opener so they send andreceive the correct codes.
The red light in HomeLink shouldbegin flashing. It will flash slowlyat first, then rapidly.
When the red light flashes rapidly,release both buttons. HomeLinkshould have learned the code fromthe remote control.
Plug in the garage door openermotor, then test the HomeLinktransceiver button by pushing it. Itshould operate the garage door.
If the button does not work, repeatthis procedure to train it again. If itstill does not work, you may have a
variable or rolling code garagedoor opener. Test this by pressingand holding the HomeLinktransceiver button you just trained.If the red light blinks for twoseconds, then stays on, you have arolling code garage door opener.You may be able to verify this withthe manufacturer’s documentation.Go to ‘‘Training With a RollingCode System.’’
Repeat these steps to train theother two HomeLink buttons tooperate any other remotely-controlled devices around yourhome (lighting, automatic gate,security system, etc.).
5.
6.8.
7.
Training With a Rolling CodeSystem
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Comfort and Convenience Features212
Information Provided by:
-
-
It may be helpful to have someoneassist you with this procedure.
Find the ‘‘Training’’ button on yourgarage door opener unit. Thelocation will vary, depending onthe manufacturer. Themanufacturer’s documentationmay help.
Press the Training button on thegarage door opener unit until thelight next to the button comes on,then release it. The light may blink,or come on and stay on. You thenhave approximately 30 seconds tocomplete the following steps.
Make sure you have properlycompleted the ‘‘TrainingHomeLink’’ procedure.
Press and hold the button onHomeLink for 3 4 seconds.(The same button you trained withthe ‘‘Training HomeLink’’procedure.)
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton again for 3 4 seconds.This should turn off the traininglight on the garage door openerunit. (Some systems may requireyou to press the button up to threetimes.)
Press the HomeLink button again.It should operate the garage door.
6.
2.
4.
5.
1.
3.
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Comfort and Convenience Features 213
TTRRAAIINNIINNGG BBUUTTTTOONN
Information Provided by:
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
To train an already programmedtransmitter button to operate a newdevice:
To erase the codes stored in all threebuttons, press and hold the twooutside buttons until the red lightbegins to flash, then release thebuttons.
Select the HomeLink button youwant to train.
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton until the red light begins toflash slowly (approximately 20seconds).
While continuing to hold theHomeLink button, place theremote control for the device 2 to5 inches from HomeLink.
Release both buttons. HomeLinkshould now be trained to operatethe device.
Press and hold the button on theremote control. Hold both buttonsuntil the red light begins to flashrapidly.
You should erase all three codesbefore selling the vehicle.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.Retraining a Button
Erasing Codes
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Comfort and Convenience Features214
Information Provided by:
Before you begin driving your Honda,you should know what gasoline touse, and how to check the levels ofimportant fluids. You also need toknow how to properly store luggageor packages. The information in thissection will help you. If you plan toadd any accessories to your vehicle,please read the information in thissection first.
.............................Break-in Period . 216.........................................Gasoline . 216
.........Service Station Procedures . 217................Filling the Fuel Tank . 217
....................Opening the Hood . 218...............................Oil Check . 220
.........Engine Coolant Check . 221...............................Fuel Economy . 222
.....................Vehicle Condition . 222...........................Driving Habits . 222
...Accessories and Modifications . 223.............................Carrying Cargo . 225
.................................Load Limit . 226
Before Driving
Before Driving 215
Information Provided by:
Help assure your vehicle’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.
You should follow these same re-commendations with an overhauledor exchanged engine, or when thebrakes are replaced.
Do not change the oil until therecommended time or mileageinterval shown in the maintenanceschedule.
Avoid hard braking. New brakesneed to be broken-in by moderateuse for the first 200 miles (300km).
We also recommend that you do nottow a trailer during the first 500miles (800 km).
Your Honda is designed to operateon unleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane number of 86 or higher. Useof a lower octane gasoline can causea persistent, heavy metallic rappingnoise in the engine that can lead tomechanical damage.
We recommend gasolines containingdetergent additives that help preventfuel system and engine deposits.
Using gasoline containing lead willdamage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols. This contributes to airpollution.
Premium fuel is recommended whentowing in certain conditions (seepage ).256
Break-in Period, Gasoline
Before Driving
Break-in Period Gasoline
216
Information Provided by:
Because the fuel fill cap is on thedriver’s side of the vehicle, parkwith that side closest to theservice station pumps.
Open the fuel fill door by pullingon the handle to the left of thedriver’s seat.
In Canada, some gasolines containan octane-enhancing additive calledMMT. If you use such gasolines,your emission control systemperformance may deteriorate andthe Malfunction Indicator Lamp onyour instrument panel may turn on.If this happens, contact yourauthorized Honda dealer for service.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Before Driving
Filling the Fuel Tank
Gasoline, Service Station Procedures
217
Pull
FUEL FILL CAP
Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.
Stop the engine and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.
Information Provided by:
Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.Place the cap in the holder on thefuel fill door.
Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank, leavesome room for the fuel to expandwith temperature changes.
Shift to Park or Neutral and setthe parking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.
Screw the fuel fill cap back on,tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. If you do not properlytighten the cap, the MalfunctionIndicator Lamp may come on (seepage ).
Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.
Your vehicle has an on-boardrefueling vapor recovery system tohelp keep fuel vapors from goinginto the atmosphere. If the fuelnozzle keeps clicking off eventhough the tank is not full, theremay be a problem with this system.Consult your dealer.
1.
3.
4.
5.
6.
349
Service Station Procedures
Before Driving
Opening the Hood
218
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
If you can open the hood withoutlifting the hood latch handle, or thehood latch handle moves stiffly ordoes not spring back as before, themechanism should be cleaned andlubricated (see page ).
Standing in front of the vehicle,put your fingers under the frontedge of the hood to the left ofcenter. Slide your hand to the leftuntil you feel the hood latchhandle. Push this handle up until itreleases the hood. Lift the hood.
Pull the support rod out of its clip,and insert the end into the hole atthe center of the hood, or the holeon the left side of the hood.
To close the hood, lift it up slightly toremove the support rod from thehole. Put the support rod back intoits holding clip. Lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then let it drop.
After closing the hood, make sure itis securely latched.
3.
2.
298
Service Station Procedures
Before Driving 219
LATCH
SUPPORT RODCLIP
Information Provided by:
Wipe the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.
Insert it all the way back in its tube.Check the engine oil level every timeyou fill the vehicle with fuel. Wait afew minutes after turning the engineoff before you check the oil.
Remove the dipstick (orangehandle).
3.2.
1.
Oil Check
Service Station Procedures
Before Driving220
DDIIPPSSTTIICCKK
Information Provided by:
Remove the dipstick again andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see
on page forinformation on adding the propercoolant.
If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .
Refer toon page for information
on checking other items in yourHonda.
4.
283
287
281
AddingEngine Coolant
Adding Oil
Owner MaintenanceChecks
Engine Coolant Check
Before Driving
Service Station Procedures
221
UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
MAX
MIN
RESERVE TANK
Information Provided by:
The condition of your vehicle andyour driving habits are the two mostimportant things that affect the fuelmileage you get.
Always maintain your vehicle accord-ing to the maintenance schedule.This will keep it in top operatingcondition.
A cold engine uses more fuel than awarm engine. It is not necessary to‘‘warm-up’’ a cold engine by letting itidle for a long time. You can driveaway in about a minute, no matterhow cold it is outside. The enginewill warm up faster, and you getbetter fuel economy. To cut down onthe number of ‘‘cold starts,’’ try tocombine several short trips into one.
You can improve fuel economy bydriving moderately. Rapid acceler-ation, abrupt cornering, and hardbraking use more fuel.
Always drive in the highest gear thatallows the engine to run and acceler-ate smoothly.
Depending on traffic conditions, tryto maintain a constant speed. Everytime you slow down and speed up,your vehicle uses extra fuel. Use thecruise control, when appropriate, toincrease fuel economy.
The air conditioning puts an extraload on the engine which makes ituse more fuel. Turn off the A/C tocut down on air conditioning use.Use the flow-through ventilationwhen the outside air temperature ismoderate.
In winter, the build-up of snow onyour vehicle’s underside adds weightand rolling resistance. Frequentcleaning helps your fuel mileage andreduces the chance of corrosion.
An important part of that mainte-nance is the
(see page ). Forexample, an underinflated tirecauses more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’which uses fuel. It also wears outfaster, so check the tire pressure atleast monthly.
281
Vehicle Condition
Driving Habits
Owner MaintenanceChecks
Before Driving
Fuel Economy
222
Information Provided by:
However, if electronic accessoriesare improperly installed, or exceedyour vehicle’s electrical systemcapacity, they can interfere with the
operation of your vehicle, or evencause the airbags to deploy.
Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper vehicle operation orperformance.
Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ).
Before installing any accessory:
When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your vehicle’scomputer-controlled systems, suchas the SRS and anti-lock brakesystem.
Modifying your vehicle, or installingsome non-Honda accessories, canmake your vehicle unsafe. Beforeyou make any modifications or addany accessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.
Your dealer has genuine Hondaaccessories that allow you topersonalize your vehicle. Theseaccessories have been designed andapproved for your vehicle, and arecovered by warranty.
Non-Honda accessories are usuallydesigned for universal applications.Although aftermarket accessoriesmay fit on your vehicle, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your vehicle’shandling and stability. (See‘‘Modifications’’ on page foradditional information.)
Have the installer contact yourHonda dealer for assistance beforeinstalling any electronic accessory.
If possible, have your Honda dealerinspect the final installation.
356
224
Accessories
Accessories and Modifications
Before Driving 223
Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourvehicle’s handling, stability andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.
Information Provided by:
Any objectattached to or placed on the coversmarked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG,’’ in thecenter of the steering wheel andon top of the dashboard, couldinterfere with the proper operationof the airbags. Or, if the airbagsinflate, the objects could bepropelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone.
If a side airbaginflates, a cup holder or other hardobject attached on or near thedoor could be propelled inside thevehicle and hurt someone.
Covering the outside edge of afront seat-back, with a non-Hondaseat cover for example, couldprevent the airbag from inflatingproperly.
Some examples are:Lowering the vehicle with anaftermarket suspension kit thatsignificantly reduces groundclearance can allow theundercarriage to impact speedbumps or other raised objects,which could cause the airbags todeploy.
Raising the vehicle with anaftermarket suspension kit canaffect the handling and stability.
Aftermarket wheels, because theyare a universal design, can causeexcessive stress on suspensioncomponents.
Do not modify your steering wheelor any other part of yourSupplemental Restraint System.Modifications could make thesystem ineffective.
If you plan to modify your vehicle,consult with your Honda dealer.
Larger or smaller wheels and tirescan interfere with the operation ofyour vehicle’s anti-lock brakes andother systems.
Removing parts from your vehicle,or replacing components with non-Honda (aftermarket) componentscould seriously affect your vehicle’shandling, stability, and reliability.
Modifications Additional Safety Precaution
Accessories and Modifications
Before Driving
Do not attach or place objects onthe airbag covers.
Do not attach hard objects on ornear a front door.
Do not place any objects over theoutside edge of a front seat-back.
224
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle has several convenientstorage areas so you can stow cargosafely.
The glove box, and the pockets inthe front doors and seat-backs, aredesigned for small, lightweight items.The cargo area is intended for larger,heavier items. The second and thirdrow seats can be folded flat to allowyou to carry more cargo or longeritems.
However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour vehicle’s handling, stability, andoperation, and make it unsafe.Before carrying any type of cargo, besure to read the following pages.
Carrying Cargo
Before Driving 225
GLOVE BOX DOOR POCKET
SEAT-BACK POCKET
CARGO AREA
Information Provided by:
Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.
Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe driver’s ability to operate thepedals, or with the properoperation of the seats.
Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If the lid is open, apassenger could injure their kneesduring a crash or sudden stop.
This figure includes the total weightof all occupants, cargo, accessories,and the tongue weight if you aretowing a trailer.
The final number is the total weightof cargo you can carry.
If you are towing a trailer, add thetongue weight to the numberabove.
Add up the weight of all occupants.
To figure out how much cargo youcan carry:
When you load luggage, the totalweight of the vehicle, all passengers,cargo, and trailer tongue load mustnot exceed the Gross VehicleWeight Rating (GVWR). The loadfor the front and rear axles also mustnot exceed the Gross Axle WeightRating (GAWR). The GVWR andGAWR are printed on the tireinformation label attached to thedriver’s doorjamb (see page ).
The maximum load for your vehicleis 1,323 lbs (600 kg).
Subtract the total from 1,323 lbs(600 kg).
360
Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment
Load Limit
Carrying Cargo
Before Driving226
Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.
Information Provided by:
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the cargo area, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible. Tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop.
If you use an accessory roof rack,the roof rack weight limit may belower. Refer to the information thatcame with your roof rack.
If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing thetailgate, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of carbon monoxidepoisoning, follow the instructionson page .
If you carry any items on a roofrack, be sure the total weight ofthe rack and the items on it doesnot exceed 165 lb (75 kg).
The hooks on each side of thetailgate and on the underside of thecargo area storage compartment lidare for plastic grocery bags. To usethe hooks on the storagecompartment lid, open the lid, andattach the cord to one of the shaftsof the third seat center headrestraint.
56
Carrying Cargo in the Cargo Areaor on a Roof Rack
Carrying Cargo
Before Driving 227
Information Provided by:
The cargo cover can be used tocover the cargo area behind the thirdrow seats. When the third row seatsare folded down, the cargo cover canbe installed in a forward position andextended over the larger cargo area.Do not install the cargo cover in theforward position if the third rowseats are not folded down.
The separation net can be used tohold back soft, lightweight itemsstored in the cargo area. Heavyitems should be properly secured onthe floor of the cargo area. The netmay not prevent heavy items frombeing thrown forward in a crash or asudden stop.
The hook on the rear of the consolecompartment is for plastic grocerybags.
On LX model
Carrying Cargo
Before Driving
Optional Separation Net
Optional Cargo Cover
228
Information Provided by:
This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmission. It alsoincludes important information onparking your vehicle, the brakingsystem, the VTM-4 System, andfacts you need if you are planning totow a trailer.
........................Driving Guidelines . 230
........................Preparing to Drive . 231.......................Starting the Engine . 232
Starting in Cold Weather....................at High Altitude . 232
..............Automatic Transmission . 233.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 233
................Shift Lever Positions . 234..............Engine Speed Limiter . 236
....................Shift Lock Release . 236Variable Torque Management
..............................4WD System . 238
..............................VTM-4 Lock . 238...........................................Parking . 240
.....................The Braking System . 241.............Brake Wear Indicators . 241
...............Brake System Design . 242.......................Anti-lock Brakes . 242
Important Safety.........................Reminders . 243........................ABS Indicator . 243
...............Driving in Bad Weather . 245...........................Towing a Trailer . 247
Towing Your Vehicle Behind a................................Motorhome . 259
..............Off-Highway Guidelines . 261
Driving
Driving 229
Information Provided by:
These advantages come at some cost.Because your vehicle is taller andrides higher off the ground, it has ahigh center of gravity. This meansthat your vehicle can tip or roll overif you make abrupt turns. Utilityvehicles have a significantly higherrollover rate than other types ofvehicles.
To prevent the risk of rollover orloss of control:
Take corners at slower speedsthan you would with a passengervehicle.
Avoid sharp turns and abruptmaneuvers whenever possible.
Do not modify your vehicle in anyway that would raise the center ofgravity.
Do not carry heavy cargo on theroof.
Your Pilot has higher groundclearance than a passenger vehicledesigned for use only on pavement.Higher ground clearance has manyadvantages for off-highway driving.It allows you to travel over bumps,obstacles, and rough terrain. It alsoprovides good visibility so you cananticipate problems earlier.
See page for additional guidelinesfor driving off-highway.
261
Driving
Driving Guidelines
230
Information Provided by:
You should do the following checksand adjustments every day beforeyou drive your vehicle.
Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.
Check the adjustment of the seat(see page ).
Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).
Check the adjustment of thesteering wheel (see page ).
Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).
Turn the ignition switch ON (II).Check the indicator lights in theinstrument panel.
Start the engine (see page ).
Check the gauges and indicatorlights in the instrument panel (seepage ).
Check that any items you may becarrying with you inside are storedproperly or fastened downsecurely.
Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure.
Check that the hood and tailgateare fully closed. Make sure the doors and tailgate
are securely closed and locked.3.
2.
1.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
11.
12.
10.
15
78 61
102232
89
Preparing to Drive
Driving 231
Information Provided by:
Apply the parking brake.
In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. If the enginedoes not start right away, do nothold the key in START (III) formore than 15 seconds at a time.Pause for at least 10 secondsbefore trying again.
If the engine does not start within15 seconds, or starts but stallsright away, repeat step 4 with theaccelerator pedal pressed half-waydown. If the engine starts, releasepressure on the accelerator pedalso the engine does not race.
If the engine still does not start,press the accelerator pedal all theway down and hold it there whilestarting in order to clear flooding.As before, keep the ignition key inthe START (III) position for nomore than 15 seconds. Return tostep 5 if the engine does not start.If it starts, lift your foot off theaccelerator pedal so the enginedoes not race.
An engine is harder to start in coldweather. The thinner air found athigh altitude above 8,000 feet (2,400meters) adds to the problem.Use the following procedure:
Turn off all electrical accessoriesto reduce the drain on the battery.
Push the accelerator pedal half-way to the floor and hold it therewhile starting the engine. Do nothold the ignition key in START(III) for more than 15 seconds.When the engine starts, releasethe accelerator pedal gradually asthe engine speeds up and smoothsout.
If the engine fails to start in step 2,push the accelerator pedal to thefloor and hold it there while youtry to start the engine for no morethan 15 seconds. If the enginedoes not start, return to step 2.
1.
2.
3.
5.
6.1.
2.
3.
4.
Starting in Cold Weather at HighAltitude (Above 8,000 feet/2,400 meters)
Starting the Engine
Driving232
Information Provided by:
This indicator on the instrumentpanel shows which position the shiftlever is in.
Your Honda’s transmission has fiveforward speeds, and is electronicallycontrolled for smoother shifting. Italso has a ‘‘lock-up’’ torque converterfor better fuel economy. You mayfeel what seems like another shiftwhen the converter locks.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch ON (II). If it flasheswhile driving (in any shift position),it indicates a possible problem in thetransmission. Avoid rapid acceler-ation and have the transmissionchecked by an authorized Hondadealer as soon as possible.
The malfunction indicator lamp maycome on along with the ‘‘D’’ indicatorif there is a problem in the automatictransmission control system.
Shift Lever Position Indicator
Automatic Transmission
Driving 233
Information Provided by:
-
The shift lever has seven positions.It must be in Park or Neutral to startthe engine. When you are stopped inD, D , 2, 1, N or R, press firmly onthe brake pedal, and keep your footoff the accelerator pedal.
This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Pull the shift levertowards you, then move it out ofPark.
If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see Shift Lock Release on page
.
You must also pull the shift levertowards you to shift into Park. Toavoid transmission damage, come toa complete stop before shifting intoPark. The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.
You cannot shift out of Park with thebrake pedal depressed when theignition switch is in LOCK (0) orACCESSORY (I).
236
3
To shift from:P to R
R to PN to RD to 22 to 11 to 2
2 to DD to DD to ND to DN to DR to N
Do this:Press the brake pedal andpull the shift lever towardsyou.
Pull the shift lever towardsyou.
Move the lever.
3
3
3
3
Shift Lever Positions Park (P)
Automatic Transmission
Driving234
SHIFT LEVER
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
-Use Neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to Park posi-tion if you need to leave the vehiclefor any reason. Press on the brake pe-dal when you are moving the shiftlever from Neutral to another gear.
To shift to Reversefrom Park, see the explanation underPark. To shift to Reverse fromNeutral, come to a complete stop andthen shift. Pull the shift levertowards you before shifting intoReverse from Neutral.
Use this position foryour normal driving. The transmis-sion automatically selects a suitablegear for your speed and acceleration.You may notice the transmissionshifting up at higher speeds whenthe engine is cold. This helps theengine warm up faster.
This position is similarto D, except only the first threegears are selected. Use D whentowing a trailer in hilly terrain, or toprovide engine braking when goingdown a steep hill. D can also keepthe transmission from cyclingbetween third and fourth gears instop-and-go driving.
For faster acceleration when in D orD, you can get the transmission toautomatically downshift by pushingthe accelerator pedal to the floor.The transmission will shift down oneor two gears, depending on yourspeed.
3
3
3
Automatic Transmission
Driving
Neutral (N)
Reverse (R)
Drive (D)
Drive (D )3
235
Information Provided by:
-
-If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce theRPM below the red zone.
When driving down hill with a trailer,use the Second position.
To shift from Secondto First, pull the shift levertowards you, then shift to thelower gear. With the lever in thisposition, the transmission locks inFirst gear. By upshifting anddownshifting through 1, 2, D andD, you can operate thistransmission much like a manualtransmission without a clutchpedal.
This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal and pulling the shift lever doesnot work.
Set the Parking brake.
Make sure the key is in theignition switch LOCK (0) position.
To shift to Second,pull the shift lever towards you, thenshift to the lower gear. This positionlocks the transmission in secondgear. It does not downshift to firstgear when you come to a stop.Second gives you more power whenclimbing, and increased enginebraking when going down steep hills.Use second gear when starting outon a slippery surface or in deep snow.It will help reduce wheelspin.
1.
2.
3
Engine Speed Limiter Shift Lock Release
First (1)
Second (2)
Automatic Transmission
Driving236
Information Provided by:
If you need to use the Shift LockRelease, it means your vehicle isdeveloping a problem. Have thevehicle checked by your Hondadealer.
Put a cloth on the edge of the ShiftLock Release slot cover.Use a small flat-tipped screwdriver or small metal plate (neitherare included in the tool kit) toremove the cover. Carefully pry onthe edge of the cover.
Insert a screwdriver in the ShiftLock Release slot.
Push down on the screwdriverwhile you pull the shift levertowards you and move it out ofPark to Neutral.
Remove the screwdriver from theshift lock release slot, then installthe cover.Depress the brake pedal andrestart the engine.
3. 4.
5.
6.
Driving
Automatic Transmission
237
Information Provided by:
The Variable Torque Management4WD System (VTM-4) automaticallytransfers varying amounts of enginetorque to the rear wheels under lowtraction conditions.
If more traction is needed when yourPilot is stuck or is likely to becomestuck, you can use the VTM-4 Lockbutton to increase torque to the rearwheels. As soon as this feature is nolonger needed, press the VTM-4Lock button again to disengage theVTM-4 Lock.
VTM-4 Lock
Variable Torque Management 4WD System
Driving238
Do not use the VTM-4 Lock button ondry, paved roads. Driving on dry,paved roads with VTM-4 Lock ON maydamage the rear dif f erential whenmaking a turn. Strange noises andvibration can also result.
Information Provided by:
To engage the VTM-4 Lock: To disengage the VTM-4 Lock, doone of the following:
The VTM-4 Lock will temporarilydisengage when the vehicle speedexceeds 18 mph (30 km/h). It willautomatically engage again as thespeed slows below 18 mph (30km/h). The light in the VTM-4 Lockbutton will remain on the whole time.
The vehicle must be stopped withthe engine running.Move the shift lever to first (1),second (2) or reverse (R) gear.Press the VTM-4 Lock button.The light in the button will comeon.
To get unstuck, apply light pressureto the accelerator pedal. Do not spinthe front tires for more than a fewseconds. Because of the amount oftorque applied to the rear tires, theyshould not spin. This is normal. Ifyou are not able to get the vehicle tomove, apply the brakes to stop thewheels, then reverse direction.
Press the VTM-4 Lock button.Move the shift lever to D, or D .Turn the ignition to OFF (0).
When you restart your Pilot, theVTM-4 Lock feature will be off.
1.
2.
3.3
Variable Torque Management 4WD System
Driving 239
Do not continuously spin the f ront tiresof your PILOT. Continuously spinningthe f ront tires can cause transmissionor rear dif f erential damage.
Information Provided by:
-
Always use the parking brake whenyou park your vehicle. The indicatoron the instrument panel shows thatthe parking brake is not fullyreleased; it does not indicate that theparking brake is firmly set. Makesure the parking brake is set firmlyor your vehicle may roll if it isparked on an incline.
Set the parking brake before you putthe transmission in Park. This keepsthe vehicle from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission making iteasier to move the shift lever out ofPark when you want to drive away.
If the vehicle is facing uphill, turnthe front wheels away from the curb.
If the vehicle is facing downhill, turnthe front wheels toward the curb.
Make sure the parking brake is fullyreleased before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat or damagethe rear brakes.
Make sure the windows are closed.
Turn off the lights.
Place any packages, valuables, etc.,in the cargo area or take themwith you.
Lock the doors with the key or theremote transmitter.
Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The three way catalyticconverter gets very hot, and couldcause these materials to catch onfire.
Parking Tips
Parking
Driving240
Information Provided by:
When the brake pads need replacing,you will hear a distinctive metallic‘‘screeching’’ sound when you applythe brakes. If you do not have thebrake pads replaced, they will beginscreeching all the time.
Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by downshifting to a lowergear and taking your foot off theaccelerator pedal.
Check your brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Since alonger distance is needed to stopwith wet brakes, be extra cautiousand alert in your driving.
Put your foot on the brake pedal onlywhen you intend to brake. Restingyour foot on the pedal keeps thebrakes applied lightly, causing themto build up heat. Heat build-up canreduce how well your brakes work. Italso keeps your brake lights on allthe time, confusing drivers behindyou.
All four brakes have audible brakewear indicators.
Your Honda is equipped with discbrakes at all four wheels. A powerassist helps reduce the effort neededon the brake pedal. The ABS helpsyou retain steering control whenbraking very hard.
Your brakes may sometimes squealor squeak when you apply themlightly. Do not confuse this with thebrake wear indicators. Theindicators make a very audible‘‘screeching.’’
Brake Wear Indicators
The Braking System
Driving 241
Information Provided by:
You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal; it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes.
this defeats thepurpose of the ABS. Let the ABSwork for you by always keeping firm,steady pressure on the brake pedalas you steer away from the hazard.This is sometimes referred to as
Activation varies with the amount oftraction your tires have. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before youactivate the ABS. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.
Your vehicle has an Anti-lock BrakeSystem (ABS) as standardequipment. ABS helps to prevent thewheels from locking up and skiddingduring hard braking, allowing you toretain steering control.
When the front tires skid, you losesteering control; the vehiclecontinues straight ahead eventhough you turn the steering wheel.The ABS helps to prevent lock-upand helps you retain steering controlby pumping the brakes rapidly; muchfaster than a person can do it.
The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.
The ABS also balances the front-torear braking distribution accordingto vehicle loading.
‘‘stomp and steer.’’
You should never pump thebrake pedal;
Anti-lock BrakesBrake System Design
The Braking System
Driving242
Front
Information Provided by:
*
*
on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock. Slow down and allow a greaterdistance between vehicles underthose conditions.
Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your vehicle to veerinto oncoming traffic or off the road.
such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safe,prudent speed for the road andweather conditions.
it only helps with steeringcontrol during braking. You shouldalways maintain a safe followingdistance from other vehicles.
The ABS is self-checking. If anythinggoes wrong, the ABS indicator onthe instrument panel comes on (seepage ). This means the anti-lockfunction of the braking system hasshut down. The brakes still work likea conventional system without anti-lock, providing normal stoppingability. You should have the dealerinspect your vehicle as soon aspossible.
63
CONTINUED
ABS IndicatorImportant Safety Reminders A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop
ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.
ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,
ABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle,
The Braking System
Driving 243
ABS INDICATOR
U.S. indicator shown
Information Provided by:
If the ABS indicator and the brakesystem indicator come on together,and the parking brake is fullyreleased, the front-to-rear brakingdistribution system may also shutdown.
Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your vehiclerepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss ofcontrol.
351
The Braking System
Driving244
Information Provided by:
- -Always driveslower than you would in dryweather. It takes your vehicle longerto react, even in conditions that mayseem just barely damp. Applysmooth, even pressure to all thecontrols. Abrupt steering wheelmovements or sudden, hard appli-cation of the brakes can cause loss ofcontrol in wet weather. Be extracautious for the first few miles(kilometers) of driving while youadjust to the change in drivingconditions. This is especially true insnow. A person can forget somesnow-driving techniques during thesummer months. Practice is neededto relearn those skills.
Exercise extra caution when drivingin rain after a long dry spell. Aftermonths of dry weather, the firstrains bring oil to the surface of theroadway, making it slippery.
Rain, fog, and snow conditions re-quire a different driving techniquebecause of reduced traction andvisibility. Keep your vehicle well-maintained and exercise greatercaution when you need to drive inbad weather. The cruise controlshould not be used in these condi-tions.
Being able to seeclearly in all directions and beingvisible to other drivers are importantin all weather conditions. This ismore difficult in bad weather. To beseen more clearly during daylighthours, turn on your headlights.
Inspect your windshield wipers andwashers frequently. Keep the wind-shield washer reservoir full of theproper fluid. Have the windshieldwiper blades replaced if they start tostreak the windshield or leave partsunwiped. Use the defrosters and airconditioning to keep the windowsfrom fogging up on the inside (seepage ).125
CONTINUED
Driving Technique Visibility
Driving in Bad Weather
Driving 245
Information Provided by:
- Check your tiresfrequently for wear and properpressure. Both are important inpreventing ‘‘hydroplaning’’ (loss oftraction on a wet surface). In thewinter, mount snow tires on all fourwheels for the best handling.
Watch road conditions carefully,they can change from moment tomoment. Wet leaves can be as slip-pery as ice. ‘‘Clear’’ roads can havepatches of ice. Driving conditionscan be very hazardous when theoutside temperature is near freezing.The road surface can becomecovered with areas of water puddlesmixed with areas of ice, so yourtraction can change without warning.
Be careful when downshifting. Iftraction is low, you can lock up thedrive wheels for a moment and causea skid.
Be very cautious when passing, orbeing passed by other vehicles. Thespray from large vehicles reducesyour visibility, and the wind buffetingcan cause you to lose control.
Traction
Driving in Bad Weather
Driving246
Information Provided by:
To safely tow a trailer, you shouldobserve the load limits, use theproper equipment, and follow theguidelines in this section.
Be sure to read thesection on page if you
plan to tow off paved surfaces.
Themaximum weight you can towdepends on several factors. Seepage for limits for your towingsituation. Towing a load that is tooheavy can seriously affect yourvehicle’s handling andperformance.
Your PILOT has been designed totow a trailer, as well as for carryingpassengers and their cargo.
The weight thatthe tongue of a fully loaded trailerputs on the hitch should be 5 to 10percent of total trailer weight forboat trailers, and 8 to 15 percent oftotal trailer weight for all othertrailers. See page for limits foryour towing situation.
261
249
249
Off-HighwayGuidelines
CONTINUED
Load Limits
Total Trailer Weight: Tongue Load:
Towing a Trailer
Driving 247
Exceeding any load limit orimproperly loading your vehicleand trailer can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriously hurtor killed.
Check the loading of yourvehicle and trailer carefullybefore starting to drive.
Information Provided by:
Too much tongue load reduces front-tire traction and steering control.Too little tongue load can make thetrailer unstable and cause it to sway.
The GCWR must be reduced 2percent for every 1,000 feet (305meters) of elevation.
The maximum allowable weight ofthe fully loaded vehicle and trailer is9700 lbs (4410 kg) with the properhitch and fluid coolers (See page
for information about fluidcoolers.)The maximum allowable weight of
the vehicle, all occupants, all cargoand the tongue load is 5,950 lbs(2,700 kg).
The maximum allowable weights onthe vehicle axles are 2865 lbs (1300kg) on the front axle, and 3,155 lbs(1,430 kg) on the rear axle.
253Gross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR):
Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR):
Gross Combined Weight Rating(GCWR):
Towing a Trailer
Driving248
Information Provided by:
*
*
*
Equipped with transmission cooler and power steering fluid cooler.
Equipped with transmission cooler and power steering fluid cooler.
Number ofOccupants
2345678
Number ofOccupants
2345678
Max. Trailer Weight
Towing is Not Recommended
Max. Tongue Load
Max. Trailer Weight Max. Tongue Load
Towing is Not Recommended
Towing a Trailer
Driving 249
The corresponding weight limits assume occupants fill seats from the front of the vehicle to the back, each occupant weighs 150 lbs (70 kg) and each has 15 lbs (7
kg) of luggage in the cargo area.
Total Trailer Weight and Tongue Load Limits:BOAT TRAILERS
OTHER TYPES OF TRAILERS
4500 lbs (2045 kg)4500 lbs (2045 kg)4500 lbs (2045 kg)4300 lbs (1945 kg)4100 lbs (1855 kg)2000 lbs (905 kg)
450 lbs (205 kg)450 lbs (205 kg)450 lbs (205 kg)350 lbs (160 kg)220 lbs (100 kg)100 lbs (45 kg)
3500 lbs (1590 kg)3500 lbs (1590 kg)3300 lbs (1490 kg)3100 lbs (1400 kg)2700 lbs (1220 kg)1200 lbs (540 kg)
450 lbs (205 kg)450 lbs (205 kg)450 lbs (205 kg)350 lbs (160 kg)220 lbs (100 kg)100 lbs (45 kg)
Information Provided by:
The best way to confirm that allloads are within limits is to checkthem at a public scale.
To help ensure a safe drive to a scale,or if you cannot get to a public scaleto check the weights of your rig, werecommended that you estimateyour total trailer weight and tongueload as described below.
To estimate your total trailer weight,add the weight of the trailer (asquoted by the trailer manufacturer)together with everything in or on thetrailer. Then refer to the tables onpage to confirm that you do notexceed the limit for your conditions.
To estimate tongue load:Park the vehicle on level ground.Measure from the ground to thebottom of the trailer hitch. Writethis number down.Connect the fully loaded trailer tothe hitch.Measure again from the ground tothe same spot on the bottom of thehitch.Subtract the result from Step 4from the result in Step 2 and referto the chart (Fig. 1).
If the difference is:1 = 150 lbs (68 kg)
1¾ = 250 lbs (114 kg)2½ = 350 lbs (160 kg)
3 = 450 lbs (204 kg)3¼ = over 450 lbs (205 kg)
If the difference is more than3¼ , you have too much tongueload at the rear. Move orremove cargo from the trailerand the vehicle, and measureagain.
If the estimated total trailer weightand tongue load do not exceed thelimits for your towing situation (seepage ), carefully drive yourtrailer to a public scale. Be sure yourvehicle and trailer are fully loaded,with all occupants and cargo youplan to take on the road.
1.2.
3.
4.
5.
249249
Estimating Loads
Total Trailer Weight
Tongue Load Fig. 1
Towing a Trailer
Driving250
’’’’’’’’’’
’’
Information Provided by:
The best way to confirm that yourvehicle and trailer loads are withinlimits is to have them checked at apublic scale. The vehicle and trailershould be fully loaded, and alloccupants should stay in the vehicle.
Check the front gross axle weight.Limit: 2865 lbs (1300 kg)
Check the gross vehicle weight.Limit: 5952 lbs (2700 kg)
If you cannot weigh the rear axledirectly, calculate the rear grossaxle weight. Subtract the weight inStep 1 from the weight in Step 2.Limit: 3153 lbs (1430 kg)
1. 2.
3.
CONTINUED
Checking Loads
Towing a Trailer
Driving 251
Information Provided by:
Check the gross combined weight. Check the weight of the hitchedtrailer. Write this number down.
Check the weight of the unhitchedtrailer. Limit: See page .
Calculate the tongue load.Subtract the weight in Step 5 fromthe weight in step 6.Limit: See page .Range: 5-10% for boat trailers
8-15% for other trailers
Gross combined weight should bedecreased 2% for every 1000 feet(305 meters) of elevation.
4. 5. 6.
7.
Limit: 249
249
Towing a Trailer
Driving252
9700 lbs (4410 kg)
Information Provided by:
Discuss any additional needs withyour trailer sales or rental agency,and make sure all equipment isproperly installed and maintained.Since local requirements may vary,check with appropriate stateauthorities to be sure that yourequipment will meet all regulationsin the areas where you plan to tow.
Always use safety chains when youtow a trailer. Make sure the chainsare secured to the trailer and hitch,and that they cross under the tongueso they can catch the trailer if itbecomes unhitched. Leave enoughslack to allow the trailer to turncorners easily, but to do not let thechains drag on the ground.
This device is recommended if yourtrailer tends to sway. Your trailermaker can tell you what kind of swaycontrol you need and how to install it.
Towing generally requires a varietyof supplemental equipment. Toensure the best quality, werecommend that you purchaseHonda equipment whenever possible.Your dealer offers a trailer packagethat includes a hitch, a ball mount, awiring harness, a transmission fluidcooler, and a heavy-duty powersteering fluid cooler.
We strongly recommend that youhave your Honda dealer install agenuine Honda hitch and therequired fluid coolers. Using non-Honda equipment may result inserious damage to your vehicle.
A weight distributing hitch is notrecommended for use with your Pilotas an improperly adjusted weightdistributing hitch may reducehandling stability and brakingperformance.
To help prevent overheating, aheavy-duty transmission fluid coolerand a heavy-duty power steeringfluid cooler are required for trailertowing. These coolers are availableonly from your Honda dealer.
CONTINUED
Towing Equipment andAccessories
Hitch
Weight Distributing Hitch
Safety Chains
Sway Control
Transmission Fluid Cooler andPower Steering Fluid Cooler
Towing a Trailer
Driving 253
Information Provided by:
There are two common types oftrailer brakes: surge and electric.Surge brakes are common for boattrailers, since the brakes will get wet.
Electric brakes must beelectronically actuated. Do notattempt to tap into your vehicle’shydraulic system. Any attempt toattach trailer brakes to your vehicle’shydraulic system will lower brakingeffectiveness and create a potentialhazard.
Honda requires that any trailer witha total trailer weight of 1000 lbs (455kg) or more have its own brakes.
See your brake manufacturer formore information on installingelectric brakes.
Trailer Brakes
Towing a Trailer
Driving254
Information Provided by:
Since lighting and wiring vary intrailer type and brand, you shouldalso have a qualified mechanic installa suitable connector between thevehicle and the trailer.
All states and Canadian provincesrequire some type of trailer lights.Check requirements for the areaswhere you plan to tow.
To get to your vehicle’s trailerlighting connector, open the tailgate,remove the cargo cover, thenremove the rear panel trim. Theconnector is on the left side. Werecommend that you have yourHonda dealer install a Honda wiringharness and converter. This harnesshas been designed and tested foryour vehicle.
If you use a non-Honda trailerlighting harness and converter, youcan get the mating connector andpins that mate with the connector inyour vehicle from your Honda dealer.
Trailer Lights
Towing a Trailer
Driving 255
GROUND(BLACK)
BACK-UP LIGHT(GREEN/BLACK)
LEFT TURN SIGNAL(GREEN/WHITE)
RIGHT TURN SIGNAL(GREEN/YELLOW)
BRAKE LIGHT(WHITE/BLACK)
TAILLIGHT(RED/BLACK)
Information Provided by:
Many states and provinces requirespecial exterior mirrors when towinga trailer. Even if they don’t, youshould install special mirrors if youcannot clearly see behind you, or ifthe trailer creates a blind spot.
We also recommend that you carry afull-size spare wheel and tire for yourtrailer. Ask your trailer sales orrental agency where and how tostore the spare.
See page for proper tire size,page for how to store a full-sizedwheel and tire, and page forinformation on changing a flat tire.Remember to unhitch the trailerbefore changing a flat.
When preparing to tow, and beforedriving away, be sure to check thefollowing:
The vehicle has been properlyserviced, and the brakes,suspension, and cooling systemare in good operating condition. Ifyou tow frequently, follow theSevere Conditions maintenanceschedule.
The lights and brakes on yourvehicle and the trailer are workingproperly.
Your vehicle tires and spare are ingood condition and properlyinflated (see page ).
The trailer tires and spare are ingood condition and inflated asrecommended by the trailermaker.
When towing a trailer, werecommend that you carry a full-sizespare wheel and tire for your vehicle.Using the compact spare that camewith the Pilot may adversely affectvehicle handling.
All items on and in the trailer areproperly secured and cannot shiftwhile you drive.
The hitch, safety chains, and anyother attachments are secure.
All weights and loads are withinlimits (see pages and ).
The trailer has been properlyserviced and is in good condition.
Towing performance can beaffected by high altitude, hightemperature, or climbing steepgrades. Therefore, premiumfuel is recommended whentowing more than 3,500 lbs(1,590 kg).
313340
335
308
247 249
Trailer Mirrors
Spare Tires
Pre-Tow Checklist
Towing a Trailer
Driving256
Information Provided by:
The added weight, length, andheight of a trailer will affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance,so driving with a trailer requiressome special driving skills andtechniques.
For your safety and the safety ofothers, take time to practice drivingmaneuvers before heading for theopen road, and follow the guidelinesdiscussed below.
Avoid towing a trailer during yourvehicle’s first 500 miles (800kilometers) (see page ).
Drive slower than normal in alldriving situations. Obey all localspeed limits for vehicles with trailers.To keep the transmission fromfrequently upshifting anddownshifting, drive in D. Whendriving with a fix-sided (e.g, camper,utility) trailer, do not exceed 55 mph(88 km/h). At higher speeds, thetrailer may sway or affect vehiclehandling.
Make turns more slowly and widerthan normal. The trailer tracks asmaller arc than your vehicle, and itcan hit or run over something thevehicle misses. Allow more time anddistance for braking. When you needto slow down, slowly lift your foot offthe throttle and gradually apply thebrakes. Do not brake or turnsuddenly as this could cause thetrailer to jackknife or turn over.
216
CONTINUED
Driving Safely With a Trailer
Break-In Period
Towing Speed Making Turns and Braking
Towing a Trailer
Driving 257
Information Provided by:
When climbing hills, closely watchyour temperature gauge. If it nearsthe red (Hot) mark, turn the airconditioning off, reduce speed and, ifnecessary, pull to the side of theroad to let the engine cool.
If the transmission shifts frequentlywhile going up a hill, shift down onegear.
If you must stop when facing uphill,use the foot brake or parking brake.Do not try to hold the vehicle inplace by pressing on the accelerator,as this can cause the automatictransmission to overheat.
When driving down hills, reduceyour speed and shift down to D . Donot ‘‘ride’’ the brakes, and rememberit will take longer to slow down andstop when towing a trailer.
Crosswinds and air turbulencecaused by passing trucks can disruptyour steering and cause your trailerto sway. When being passed by atruck or other large vehicle, keep aconstant speed and steer straightahead. Do not try to make quicksteering or braking corrections.
Always drive slowly and havesomeone guide you when backing up.Grip the of the steeringwheel; then turn the wheel to the leftto get the trailer to move to the left,and turn the wheel right to move thetrailer to the right.
Follow all normal precautions whenparking, including putting thetransmission in PARK and firmlysetting the parking brake when youhave finished parking.
Do not park on an incline unless it isunavoidable. If you must park on anincline, turn the vehicle wheelstoward the curb on a downhill andaway from the curb on an uphill.After parking, place wheel chocks ateach trailer tire, on the downhill side.
If the vehicle wheels slip whenretrieving a boat from the water,shift to first gear and turn on VTM-4Lock (see page ).
Disengage VTM-4 Lock as soon asthe boat is out of the water toprevent damage to the VTM-4system.
2383
bottom
Driving on Hills Handling Crosswinds andTurbulence
Backing Up
Parking
Retrieving a Boat
Towing a Trailer
Driving258
Information Provided by:
When purchasing a tow bar, makesure you select a reputablemanufacturer and installer. Followthe manufacturer’s attachmentinstructions carefully.
If you tow more than 8 hours in oneday, you should repeat the aboveprocedure at least every 8 hours.(when you stop for fuel, etc.)
Check the transmission fluid level(see page ).
Maintaining the correct fluid levelis very important.
Start the engine.
Leave the ignition switch inACCESSORY (I) so the steeringwheel does not lock. Make surethe radio and any items pluggedinto the accessory power socketsare turned off so you do not rundown the battery.
Release the parking brake.
Your Pilot can be towed behind amotorhome at legal highway speedsup to 65 mph (100 km/h). Do notexceed 65 mph (100 km/h).Otherwise, severe transmissiondamage will occur. To avoid damageto the 4WD system, it must be towedwith all four wheels on the ground(flat towing).
Press on the brake pedal. Shift thelever through all the positions (P,R, N, D, D , 2, 1)
Shift to D, then to N. Let theengine run for three minutes, thenturn off the engine.
Do the following to prepare yourPilot for ‘‘flat towing.’’ Perform thisprocedure every day immediatelybefore you begin towing, and followthis procedure exactly; otherwise,severe automatic transmissiondamage will occur.
293
Do not overfill.
CONTINUED
3
Extended Towing
Towing Your Vehicle Behind a Motorhome
Driving 259
Information Provided by:
Replace the transmission fluid everytwo years or 30,000 miles (48,000km), whichever comes first.
Towing Your Vehicle Behind a Motorhome
Driving260
The steering system can be damaged ifthe steering wheel is locked. Leave theignition switch in Accessory (I), andmake sure the steering wheel turnsf reely bef ore you begin towing.
Improper towing preparation willdamage the transmission. Follow theabove procedure exactly. If you cannotshif t the transmission or start theengine, your vehicle must betransported on a f lat-bed or trailer.
Information Provided by:
Your Pilot has been designedprimarily for use on pavement. Butits higher ground clearance and four-wheel drive VTM-4 system allow youto occasionally travel on unpavedroads, to campgrounds, picnic sites,and similar locations. It is notdesigned for trailblazing, mountainclimbing, or other challenging off-road activities.
If you decide to drive on unpavedroads, you will find that it requiressomewhat different driving skills.Your Pilot will also handle somewhatdifferently than it does on pavement.So be sure to read this owner’smanual, pay special attention to theprecautions and tips in this section,and get acquainted with your vehiclebefore you leave the pavement.
General Information
Off-Highway Guidelines
Driving 261
Information Provided by:
The route presents limits (someroads are too steep and bumpy forexample). You have limits (in drivingskills and comfort). And your vehiclealso has limits (traction, stability, andpower, for instance).
Driving off-highway can behazardous if you fail to recognizelimits and take proper precautions.For example, you can have anaccident or rollover duringmaneuvers such as turning, drivingon hills, or over large obstacles.
On many unpaved roads, you won’tfind lane markers, traffic signals, orsigns to warn you of possible troubleahead. It’s up to you to continuallyassess the situation and drive withinlimits.
Remember that your Pilot has higherground clearance and a highercenter of gravity than passengervehicles designed for use only onpavement. This means your vehiclecan more easily tip or roll over if youmake abrupt turns or drive on slopes.
Be sure to store cargo properly, anddo not exceed your Pilot cargo loadlimits (see pages and ).
Utility vehicles have a significantlyhigher rollover rate than other typesof vehicles. To avoid loss of controlor rollover, be sure to follow allrecommendations and precautionson page and in this section.
Seat belts are just as important off-road as on paved roads. Whereveryou drive, make sure you and yourpassengers always wear seat belts. Ifchildren or infants are along for theride, see that they are properlysecured. In a rollover crash, anunbelted person is more likely to diethan a person wearing a seat belt.
230
226 247
Important Safety Precautions
Off-Highway Guidelines
Driving262
Improperly operating thisvehicle on or off-pavement cancause an accident or rollover inwhich you and your passengerscould be seriously injured orkilled.
Follow all instructions andguidelines in the owner’smanual.Keep your speed low anddon’t drive faster thanconditions permit.
Information Provided by:
The following pages contain practicaltips on basic off-highway operation.
Driving off-highway can be hard on avehicle. Before you leave thepavement, be sure all scheduledmaintenance and service has beendone, and that you have inspectedyour vehicle. Pay special attention tothe condition of the tires, and use agauge to check the tire pressures.
Off-highway, the general rule is tokeep your speed low. Of course,you’ll need enough speed to keepmoving forward. But at higherspeeds, you have less time to assessconditions and make good decisions.There’s also a greater chance ofsliding if you brake or turn tooquickly on wet soil, gravel, or ice. Inany situation, never go faster thanconditions allow.
Generally, the best off-pavementbraking technique is to gentlydepress the brake pedal, thenincrease pressure as more braking isneeded. Avoid hard braking. Keep inmind that you will usually need moretime and distance to brake to a stopon unpaved surfaces.
After you return to the pavement,carefully inspect your vehicle tomake sure there is no damage thatcould make driving it unsafe. Checkthe tires for damage and for properpressure.
If you need to brake hard because ofan emergency, apply steady, evenpressure to the brake pedal. Do notpump the brakes; let the anti-lockbraking system pump them for you.If you pump the brakes, the anti-lockcannot work as efficiently, and yourstopping distance may be increased.
For better traction on all surfaces,accelerate slowly and gradually buildup speed. If you try to start too faston wet soil, mud, snow, or ice, youmight not have enough traction toget underway. You may even digyourself into a hole. Starting with theshift lever in second gear (2) willhelp get you to a smooth start onsnow and ice.
CONTINUED
Controlling Speed
Check Out Your Vehicle
Accelerating and Braking
Driving Tips
Off-Highway Guidelines
Driving 263
Information Provided by:
Test your brakes from time to timeto make sure they are operatingproperly. This will also give you afeel for how much traction you haveon a given surface.
Off-highway, the basic turningtechnique is to drive at low speedand gradually adjust the amount ofsteering to suit the surface.
You should have no problem makingsharp turns at low speed on levelground. But never make an abruptturn at higher speeds, on or offpavement. With a higher center ofgravity, your vehicle can more easilytip or roll over.
Before driving up or down a hill, stopand assess the situation. If you can’tclearly see all road conditions (goodtraction, no bumps, holes or otherobstacles, a safe way out, etc.) walkthe slope before you drive on it. Ifyou have any doubt about whetheryou can safely drive on the slope,
. Find another route.
If you are driving up a hill and findthat you cannot continue (because ofthe steepness, a large obstacle, etc.),
. Your vehiclecould roll over. Slowly back down thehill, following the same route youtook up the hill.
Bumps, holes, rocks, and otherobstacles can be hazardous. Debrisin the road can damage yoursuspension or other components.Even small rocks can cut your tires.
More important, because yourvehicle has a high center of gravity,driving over a large obstacle, orallowing a wheel to drop into a deephole, can cause your vehicle to tip orroll over.
Drive slow enough to observeobstacles ahead and maneuveraround them. If you can’t avoid aserious obstacle, turn around andlook for a better route.
don’t do it
do not try to turn around
Turning
Avoiding ObstaclesDriving on Slopes
Off-Highway Guidelines
Driving264
Information Provided by:
Before driving through water, stopand make sure that:
The water is never deep enough tocover your wheel hubs, axles orexhaust pipe. You could stall, andnot be able to restart the engine.The water could also damageimportant vehicle components.
The water is not flowing too fast.Deep rushing water can sweep youdownstream. Even very shallowrushing water can wash theground from under your tires andcause you to lose traction andpossibly roll over.
The banks are sloped so you candrive out.
The banks and surface under thewater provide good traction. Thewater may hide hazards such asrocks, holes, or mud.
If you decide it’s safe to drivethrough water, choose a suitablespeed and engage VTM-4 Lock (seepage ), then proceed withoutshifting or changing speed. Do notstop the vehicle or shut off theengine while trying to cross a stream.After driving through water, testyour brakes. If the brakes got wet,drive slowly while gently pumpingthe brakes until they operatenormally.If the water is deeper than the wheelhubs, some additional service to theengine, transmission and differentialmay be required. This service is notcovered by your warranties.
238
Crossing a Stream
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Driving 265
Information Provided by:
If you get stuck, engage the VTM-4Lock mode (see page ).Carefully try to go in the direction(forward or reverse) that you thinkwill give you the best chance ofgetting unstuck.
Do not spin the tires at high speeds.It will not help you get out and maycause damage to the transmission orthe VTM-4 system.
You should never use a jack to trygetting unstuck. A jack only workson firm, level ground. Also, yourvehicle could easily slip off the jackand hurt you or someone else.
You may be able to safely tow a lightweight trailer (such as a motorcycletrailer or small tent trailer) off-road ifyou follow these guidelines:
Do not exceed a trailer weight of1,000 pounds (450 kg) (includingcargo) or a tongue weight of 100pounds (45 kg).(Tongue weightshould be about 10% of the trailerweight.)
If you are unable to free yourself,you will need to be pulled out byanother vehicle. Your Pilot isequipped with front and rear towhooks designed for this purpose.
Use a nylon strap to attach the Pilotto the recovery vehicle, and carefullytake out the slack in the strap. Oncethe strap is tight, the recoveryvehicle should apply force.Remember that the recovery vehicleneeds good traction to avoidbecoming stuck, too.
238
If You Get Stuck Towing a Trailer
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Driving266
Information Provided by:
Try to stay on smooth, level dirtroads, and avoid driving in hillyterrain.
Allow extra room for starting,stopping, and turning.
Slow down if you encounter bumpsor other obstacles.
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Driving 267
Information Provided by:
268
Information Provided by:
This section explains the importanceof keeping your vehicle wellmaintained and why you shouldfollow basic maintenance safetyprecautions.
This section also includesMaintenance Schedules for normaldriving and severe driving conditions,a Maintenance Record, and instruc-tions for simple maintenance tasksyou may want to take care ofyourself.
If you have the skills and tools to per-form more complex maintenancetasks on your Honda, you may wantto purchase the Service Manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your Hondadealer.
......................Maintenance Safety . 270.Important Safety Precautions . 271
.................Maintenance Schedule . 272...Required Maintenance Record . 279
.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 281..............................Fluid Locations . 282
......................................Engine Oil . 283..................................Adding Oil . 283
....................Recommended Oil . 283..............................Synthetic Oil . 284
....................................Additives . 284.....Changing the Oil and Filter . 285
.............................Cooling System . 287............Adding Engine Coolant . 287
.......Replacing Engine Coolant . 289....................Windshield Washers . 292
....Automatic Transmission Fluid . 293..........................Differential Fluid . 294
....................................Brake Fluid . 295............................Brake System . 295
..............................Power Steering . 296.....................Air Cleaner Element . 297
....................................Hood Latch . 298
....................................Spark Plugs . 299..............................Replacement . 299............................Specifications . 301
...........................................Battery . 302.................................Wiper Blades . 304
..............Air Conditioning System . 306..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 307
.....................................Drive Belts . 307....................................Timing Belt . 308
...............................................Tires . 308......................................Inflation . 308
..................................Inspection . 310..............................Maintenance . 311.............................Tire Rotation . 311
...Replacing Tires and Wheels . 312......................Wheels and Tires . 313
..........................Winter Driving . 313.............................Snow Tires . 314............................Tire Chains . 314
.............................................Lights . 315.....................Headlight Aiming . 317
........................Replacing Bulbs . 317....................Storing Your Vehicle . 324
377
Maintenance
Maintenance 269
Information Provided by:
Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.
Regularly maintaining your vehicle isthe best way to protect yourinvestment. Proper maintenance isessential to your safety and thesafety of your passengers. It will alsoreward you with more economical,trouble-free driving, and help reduceair pollution.
This section includes instructions forsimple maintenance tasks, such aschecking and adding oil. Any serviceitems not detailed in this sectionshould be performed by a Hondatechnician or other qualifiedmechanic.
Maintenance Safety
Maintenance270
Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.
Improperly maintaining thisvehicle or failing to correct aproblem before driving cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.
Information Provided by:
Before you begin any maintenance,make sure your vehicle is parked onlevel ground and that the parkingbrake is set. Also, be sure the engineis off. This will help to eliminateseveral potential hazards:
Be surethere is adequate ventilationwhenever you operate the engine.
Let theengine and exhaust system coolbefore touching any parts.
Read the instructions before youbegin, and make sure you have thetools and skills required.
To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, be careful when workingaround gasoline or batteries. Use acommercially available degreaser orparts cleaner, not gasoline, to cleanparts. Keep cigarettes, sparks, andflames away from the battery and allfuel-related parts.
Donot run the engine unless in-structed to do so.
You should wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingnear the battery or when usingcompressed air.
Maintenance Safety
Maintenance
Important Safety Precautions
Carbon monoxide poisoningfrom engine exhaust.
Burns from hot parts.
Injury from moving parts.
271
Information Provided by:
The Maintenance Schedule specifieshow often you should have yourvehicle serviced and what thingsneed attention. It is essential thatyou have your vehicle serviced asscheduled to retain its high level ofsafety, dependability, and emissionscontrol performance.
Service your vehicle according to thetime and mileage periods on one ofthe Maintenance Schedules on thefollowing pages. Select the schedulefor ‘‘Severe Conditions’’ if most ofyour driving is done under one ormore of the conditions listed on thatpage. Otherwise, follow the schedulefor ‘‘Normal Conditions.’’The services and time or distance
intervals shown in the maintenanceschedule assume you will use yourvehicle as normal transportation forpassengers and their possessions.You should also follow theserecommendations:
Avoid exceeding your vehicle’sload limit. This puts excess stresson the engine, brakes, and manyother parts of your vehicle. Theload limit is shown on the tireinformation label on the driver’sdoorjamb.
Operate your vehicle onreasonable roads within the legalspeed limit.
Drive your vehicle regularly over adistance of several miles(kilometers).
Always use unleaded gasoline withthe proper octane rating (see page
).216
Maintenance Schedule
Maintenance
Which Schedule to Follow:
272
Information Provided by:
#
U.S. Vehicles:
Your authorized Honda dealerknows your vehicle best and canprovide competent, efficient service.However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Keep all thereceipts as proof of completion, andhave the person who does the workfill out the Maintenance Record.Check your warranty booklet formore information.
We recommend the use of genuineHonda parts and fluids whenever youhave maintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.
According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, Hondarecommends that all maintenanceservices be performed at therecommended time or mileageperiod to ensure long-term reliability.
Maintenance Schedule
Maintenance
Maintenance, replacement orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems may be doneby any automotive repairestablishment or individual usingparts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPAstandards.
273
Information Provided by:
-
#
#
#
#
#
Follow the Normal ConditionsMaintenance Schedule if thesevere driving conditionsspecified in the SevereConditions MaintenanceSchedule do not apply.
NOTE: If you onlydrive under a
‘‘severe’’ condition, you shouldfollow the Normal ConditionsMaintenance Schedule.
Follow the MaintenanceSchedule for Severe Conditions.
OCCASIONALLY
Maintenance
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
274
Visually inspect the following items:
Replace every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 1 year
Check oil and coolant at each fuel stop
Service at the indicateddistance or time whichevercomes first.
miles x 1,000km x 1,000months
Replace engine oilReplace engine oil filterCheck engine oil and coolantReplace air cleaner elementInspect valve clearanceReplace spark plugsReplace timing belt , and inspect water pumpInspect and adjust drive beltsInspect idle speedReplace engine coolant
Replace transmission fluidReplace VTM-4 rear differential fluidInspect front and rear brakesReplace brake fluidCheck parking brake adjustmentReplace dust and pollen filterRotate tires (Check tire inflation and condition atleast once per month)
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsCooling system hoses and connectionsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections
Rotate tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, last column, page .
120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 5 years
7.5126
152412
Every 3 years (independent of mileage)
304824
457236
609648
7512060
9014472
10516884
12019296
Adjust only if noisy
273:
Maintenance
ScheduleforN
ormalConditions
Information Provided by:
□□□□□□□□□□
□□□□□□□
□□
□
□
□□□ □□
□□
#
#
*
#
#
#
*
Maintenance 275
Canadian owners:
A, B, C, D
A
B
C
D
Follow the schedule for Severe Conditions.
Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time interval. Follow thisschedule if the severe driving conditions described in the Severe Conditions Schedule on the next page do not apply.
7,500 mi/12,000 km15,000 mi/24,000 km/1 yr22,500 mi/36,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs37,500 mi/60,000 km3 yrs45,000 mi/72,000 km/3 yrs52,500 mi/84,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/4 yrs67,500 mi/108,000 km75,000 mi/120,000 km/5 yrs82,500 mi/132,000 km6 yrs90,000 mi/144,000 km/6 yrs97,500 mi/156,000 km105,000 mi/168,000 km/7 yrs
112,500 mi/180,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/8 yrs9 yrs120,000 mi/192,000 km/10 yrsthen every 60,000 mi/96,000 km/5 yrs
Replace engine oil.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 311 ).Replace engine oil filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Check parking brake adjustment.Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect cooling system hoses and connections.Inspect exhaust system .Inspect fuel lines and connections .Replace air cleaner element.Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace dust and pollen filter.Replace rear differential fluid.
Do items in A.Do items in A, B, DDo items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Replace transmission fluid. Do items in A, B.
Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.
Replace transmission fluid. Do items in A, B.Do items in A.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Do items in A, B, C, D.Do items in A.
Replace timing belt , and inspect water pump.Replace transmission fluid.Inspect idle speed . Inspect valve clearance.Replace spark plugs. Do items in A, B.
Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Replace engine coolant.
••
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .Necessary for proper break-in of the VTM-4 rear differential.
Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.
NOTE:
:
1:273
1
Maintenance
Schedule
forNorm
alConditions
(listedby
distance/time)
Information Provided by:
-
-
*
*
*
##
#
# *
#
*
*
Follow the MaintenanceSchedule for Severe Conditions.
Driving less than 5 miles (8 km)per trip or, in freezingtemperatures, driving less than10 miles (16 km) per trip.Driving in extremely hot [over90°F (32°C)] conditions.Extensive idling or long periodsof stop-and-go driving.Trailer towing, driving with aroof top carrier, or driving inmountainous conditions.Driving on muddy, dusty, or de-iced roads.
Follow the Severe ConditionsMaintenance Schedule if you driveyour vehicle MAINLY under one ormore of the following conditions:
Maintenance
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
276
Visually inspect the following items:
Replace every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months
Service at the indicateddistance or time whichevercomes first.
miles x 1,000km x 1,000months
Inspect every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months
Check oil and coolant at each fuel stop
Rotate tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and conditions of fluidsCooling system hoses and connectionsExhaust systemFuel lines and connectionsLights and controlsVehicle underbody
Every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months
152412
304824
457236
609648
7512060
9014472
10516884
12019296
Follow this schedule for rear differentialfluid replacement if you use your vehiclefor off-highway driving, trailer towing,or mainly in stop-and go driving.Otherwise, use the fluid replacementschedule in the Maintenance Schedulefor Normal Conditions.
Every 3 years (independent of mileage)
120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 5 years
Replace engine oil and oil filterCheck engine oil and coolantReplace air cleaner element
Use normal schedule except in dustyconditions
Inspect valve clearanceReplace spark plugsReplace timing belt and inspect water pumpInspect and adjust drive beltsInspect idle speedReplace engine coolant
Replace transmission fluidReplace VTM-4 rear differential fluidInspect front and rear brakesReplace brake fluidCheck parking brake adjustmentReplace dust and pollen filterLubricate all hinges, locks and latchesRotate tires (Check tire inflation and condition atleast once per month)
7.5126
Adjust only if noisy
Refer to page 308 for replacementinformation under special drivingconditions.Refer to page 307 for replacementinformation under special drivingconditions.
1 :
2 :
3 :
: See page 273.
, 1
3
2
Maintenance
ScheduleforS
evereConditions
Information Provided by:
-
□
-
□□□□□□□
□□
□□
□□□□□□□□□
*
#
#
*
*
CONTINUEDMaintenance 277
A, B, C, D, E
Canadian Owners
U.S. Owners
B
C
A
D
E
Service at the indicated distance or time, whichever comes first. Do the items in as required for each distance/time.
Use the Maintenance Schedule for Severe Conditions.
3,750 mi/6,000 km7,500 mi/12,000 km/6 mos11,250 mi/18,000 km15,000 mi/24,000 km/1 yr18,750 mi/30,000 km22,500 mi/36,000 km26,250 mi/42,000 km30,000 mi/48,000 km/2 yrs33,750 mi/54,000 km37,500 mi/60,000 km41,250 mi/66,000 km3 yrs45,000 mi/72,000 km/3 yrs48,750 mi/78,000 km52,500 mi/84,000 km56,250 mi/90,000 km60,000 mi/96,000 km/4 yrs63,750 mi/102,000 km67,500 mi/108,000 km71,250 mi/114,000 km
Do items in A.Do items in A, B, E .Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Do items in A, B, C, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.
Refer to page to determine which schedule to use.
Replace engine oil and filter.Inspect front and rear brakes.Rotate tires (follow pattern on page 311 ).Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox and boots.Inspect suspension components.Inspect driveshaft boots.Replace air cleaner element every 15,000 mi(24,000 km) under dusty conditions. Otherwise, useNormal Conditions schedule.Check parking brake adjustment.Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches withmultipurpose grease.Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS).Check all fluid levels, condition of fluids, and checkfor leaks.Inspect cooling system hoses and connections.Inspect exhaust system .Inspect fuel lines and connections .Check all lights.Inspect the underbody.Inspect and adjust drive belts.Replace transmission fluid.Replace dust and pollen filter .Replace rear differential fluid .
276
4
2
3
Maintenance
Schedule
forSevere
Conditions
(listedby
distance/time)
Information Provided by:
□
□
□ □□
□□
* #
#
#
**
*
*
Maintenance278
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty, lastcolumn, page .See timing belt on page to determine need for replacement.See dust and pollen filter on page for replacementinformation under special driving conditions.Follow this schedule for rear differential fluid replacement if youuse your vehicle for off-highway driving, trailer towing, ormainly in stop-and go driving. Otherwise, use the fluidreplacement schedule in the Maintenance Schedule for NormalConditions.Necessary for proper break-in of the VTM-4 rear differential.
Check engine oil and coolant at each fuel stop.Check and adjust valve clearance, cold engine, only if noisy.
NOTE:
:
1:2:
3:
4:
273308
307
Do items in A, B, C, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Do items in A, B, C, D, E.Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.
Replace timing belt , and inspect waterpump.
Inspect valve clearance. Replace spark plugs.Inspect idle speed . Do items in A, B, C, E.
Do items in A.Do items in A, B.Do items in A.Do items in A, B, C, D, E.
Replace brake fluid (independent of mileage)Replace engine coolant.
75,000 mi/120,000 km/5 yrs78,750 mi/126,000 km82,500 mi/132,000 km86,250 mi/138,000 km6 yrs90,000 mi/144,000 km/6 yrs93,750 mi/150,000 km97,500 mi/156,000 km101,250 mi/162,000 km105,000 mi/168,000 km/7 yrs
108,750 mi/174,000 km112,500 mi/180,000 km116,250 mi/186,000 km120,000 mi/192,000 km/8 yrs9 yrs120,000 mi/ 192,000 km/10 yrsthen every 60,000 mi/96,000 km/5 yrs
••
1,
Maintenance
ScheduleforS
evereConditions
(listed
bydistance/time)
Information Provided by:
CONTINUEDMaintenance
Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)
279
33,750 mi
37,500 mi
41,250 mi
45,000 mi
48,750 mi
52,500 mi
56,250 mi
60,000 mi
3,750 mi
7,500 mi
11,250 mi
15,000 mi
18,750 mi
22,500 mi
26,250 mi
30,000 mi
You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here, whether you follow the schedule for normal conditions (page ) or severeconditions (page ). Keep the receipts for all work done on your vehicle.
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
Signature or dealer stamp Signature or dealer stamp mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
54,000 km
60,000 km
66,000 km
72,000 km(or 3 years)
78,000 km
84,000 km
90,000 km
96,000 km(or 4 years)
6,000 km
12,000 km
18,000 km
24,000 km(or 1 year)
30,000 km
36,000 km
42,000 km
48,000 km(or 2 years)
274276
Information Provided by:
Maintenance
Required Maintenance Record (for Normal and Severe Schedules)
280
63,750 mi
67,500 mi
71,250 mi
75,000 mi
78,750 mi
82,500 mi
86,250 mi
90,000 mi
93,750 mi
97,500 mi
101,250 mi
105,000 mi
108,750 mi
112,500 mi
116,250 mi
120,000 mi
Signature or dealer stamp mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
Signature or dealer stamp mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
mi/km
Date
102,000 km
108,000 km
114,000 km
120,000 km(or 5 years)
126,000 km
132,000 km
138,000 km
144,000 km(or 6 years)
150,000 km
156,000 km
162,000 km
168,000 km(or 7 years)
174,000 km
180,000 km
186,000 km
192,000 km(or 8 years)
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
-
-
-
You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the page given.
Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .
Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .
Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page
.
Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page
.
Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .
Lights Check the operation ofthe headlights, parking lights,taillights, high-mount brake light,turn signals, brake lights, andlicense plate lights monthly. Seepage .
220
221
293
295
308
315
Owner Maintenance Checks
Maintenance 281
Information Provided by:
Fluid Locations
Maintenance282
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK(Orange loop)
WASHER FLUID(Blue cap)
COOLANTRESERVOIR
POWER STEERINGFLUID (Red cap) RADIATOR CAP ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSIONFLUID DIPSTICK(Yellow loop)
BRAKE FLUID(Gray cap)
Information Provided by:
To add oil, unscrew and remove theengine oil fill cap on top of the valvecover. Pour in the oil, and install theengine oil fill cap. Tighten it securely.Wait a few minutes and recheck theoil level. Do not fill above the uppermark; you could damage the engine.
Make sure the API Certification Sealsays ‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’
Pour the oil slowly and carefully soyou do not spill. Clean up any spillsimmediately. Spilled oil coulddamage components in the engine
compartment.
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred5W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foroptimum engine protection.
Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-grade 5W-20detergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements.
CONTINUED
Adding Oil
Recommended Oil
Engine Oil
Maintenance 283
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
API CERTIFICATION SEAL
Information Provided by:
You may use a synthetic motor oil ifit meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Seal,and it is the proper weight as shownon the chart. When using syntheticoil, you must follow the oil and filterchange intervals given in themaintenance schedule.
The oil’s viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label.Select the oil for your vehicleaccording to this chart.
5W-20 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your Honda, toimprove cold weather starting, andto help your engine use less fuel.
Your Honda does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect your engine’s or transmission’sperformance and durability.
Engine Oil
Maintenance
Synthetic Oil
Additives
284
Ambient Temperature
Information Provided by:
Open the hood and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.
Always change the oil and filteraccording to the time and distance(miles/kilometers) recommenda-tions in the maintenance schedule.The oil and filter collect contami-nants that can damage your engine ifthey are not removed regularly.
Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the vehicle. The vehicleshould be raised on a service station-type hydraulic lift for this service.Unless you have the knowledge andproper equipment, you should havethis maintenance done by a skilledmechanic.
Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Engine Oil
Maintenance
Changing the Oil and Filter
285
WASHER DRAIN BOLT
Information Provided by:
Install a new oil filter according toinstructions that come with it.
Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten it to:
Refill the engine with the recom-mended oil.Engine oil change capacity(including filter):
Remove the oil filter and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourHonda dealer) is required toremove the filter.
Replace the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator light should go out withinfive seconds. If it does not, turn offthe engine and check your work.
Let the engine run for severalminutes, then check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.
Turn off the engine, let it sit forseveral minutes, then check the oillevel. If necessary, add oil to bringthe level to the upper mark on thedipstick.
9.
8.
7.
6.
4.
5.
3.
Engine Oil
Maintenance286
OIL FILTER
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
5.1 US qt (4.8 , 4.2 Imp qt)
Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmful to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.
Information Provided by:
If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.The coolant you add should alwaysbe a mixture of 50 percent antifreezeand 50 percent water. Never addstraight antifreeze or plain water.
If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.
Always use Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2. Thiscoolant is pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent water. Itdoes not require any additionalmixing.
If it is not available, you may useanother major-brand non-silicatecoolant as a temporary replacement.Make sure it is a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.However, continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result incorrosion, causing the coolingsystem to malfunction or fail. Havethe cooling system flushed andrefilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.
CONTINUED
Adding Engine Coolant
Cooling System
Maintenance 287
RESERVE TANK
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
Information Provided by:
Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.
Turn the radiator cap counter-clockwise, without pressing downon it, until it stops. This relievesany pressure remaining in thecooling system.
Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.
The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.
Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your vehicle’scooling system. They may not becompatible with the coolant orengine components.
Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.
Pour the coolant slowly andcarefully so you do not spill. Cleanup any spills immediately. Spilledcoolant could damage componentsin the engine compartment.
Put the radiator cap back on.Tighten it fully.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
Cooling System
Maintenance288
RESERVE TANK
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
Loosen the drain plug on thebottom of the radiator. Thecoolant will drain through thesplash guard.
The cooling system should becompletely drained and refilled withnew coolant according to the timeand distance recommendations inthe maintenance schedule. Only useHonda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2. Use of any non-Honda coolant or plain water canresult in corrosion and deposits inthe cooling system.
Draining the coolant requires accessto the underside of the vehicle.Unless you have the tools andknowledge, you should have thismaintenance done by a skilledmechanic.
Turn the ignition ON (II). Set theClimate control system to 90°F(32°C) or turn the temperaturecontrol dial to maximum. Turn theignition off.Open the hood. Make sure theengine and radiator are cool to thetouch.
Remove the radiator cap.
1. 3.
2.
Replacing Engine Coolant
Cooling System
Maintenance 289
DRAIN PLUG
Information Provided by:
When the coolant stops draining,tighten the drain plug at thebottom of the radiator.
Tighten the drain bolt at the rearof the engine cylinder blocksecurely.Tightening torque:
Remove the reserve tank from itsholder by pulling it straight up.Drain the coolant, then put thetank back in its holder.
Install a rubber hose on the drainbolt in the back of the engineblock. Loosen the drain bolt.
6.
4. 5.
7.
Cooling System
Maintenance290
DRAIN BOLT RESERVE TANK
HOLDER
RESERVETANK CAP
7 lbf·ft (10 N·m , 1.0 kgf·m)
Information Provided by:
Fill the reserve tank to the MAXmark. Install the reserve tank cap.
Install the radiator cap, andtighten it to the first stop.
Start the engine and let it run untilthe radiator cooling fan comes onat least twice. Then stop theengine.
Remove the radiator cap. Fill theradiator with coolant up to thebase of the filler neck.
Install the radiator cap, andtighten it fully.
Pour Honda All SeasonAntifreeze/Coolant Type 2 intothe radiator up to the base of thefiller neck. This coolant is amixture of 50 percent antifreezeand 50 percent water. Pre-mixingis not required.The cooling system capacity is:
10.
11.
12.
13.
9.
8.
Cooling System
Maintenance 291
FILLER NECK
Fill up to here
1.74 US gal (6.6 , 1.45 Imp gal)
Information Provided by:
Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.
When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition the blade edges.
Check the level in the windshieldwasher reservoir at least monthlyduring normal use. In bad weather,when you use the washers often,check the level every time you stopfor fuel.
The low washer level indicator willlight when the level is low (see page
).65
On Canadian models
Windshield Washers
Maintenance292
Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir.
Antif reeze can damage your vehicle’spaint, while a vinegar/water solutioncan damage the windshield washerpump.
Use only commercially-availablewindshield washer f luid.
Information Provided by:
Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.
Park the vehicle on level ground.Shut off the engine.
Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission and wipe itwith a clean cloth.
Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission.
Remove the dipstick and check
the fluid level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
To thoroughly flush thetransmission, the technicianshould drain and refill it withHonda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid), then drivethe vehicle a short distance. Dothis three times. Then drain andrefill the transmission a final time.
The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid accordingto the time and distance recommen-dations in the maintenance schedule.
Insert the dipstick all the way backin the transmission.
If the level is below the lowermark, add fluid into the tube tobring it to the upper mark. Alwaysuse Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid). If it is notavailable, you may use aDEXRON III automatictransmission fluid as a temporaryreplacement. However, continued
use can affect shift quality. Havethe transmission flushed andrefilled with Honda ATF-Z1 assoon as it is convenient.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your Honda dealer.
1.
2.
3.
5.
6.
4.
Maintenance
Automatic Transmission Fluid
293
DIPSTICK
DIPSTICK
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARK
Information Provided by:
Put a new washer on the filler bolt,then reinstall the filler bolt. Tightenit securely. Tightening torque:
The differential should be drainedand refilled with new fluid accordingto the time and distancerecommendations in themaintenance schedule.
Check the fluid level with thedifferential at normal operatingtemperature and the vehicle sittingon level ground. Remove thedifferential fluid filler bolt andwasher, and carefully feel inside thebolt hole with your finger. The fluidlevel should be up to the edge of thebolt hole. If it is not, slowly addVTM-4 Differential Fluid until itstarts to run out of the hole.
Maintenance
Differential Fluid
294
FILLER BOLT
CORRECT LEVEL
33 lbf·ft (45 N·m , 4.6 kgf·m)
Information Provided by:
The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement. However, the use ofany non-Honda brake fluid can causecorrosion and decrease the life of thesystem. Have the brake systemflushed and refilled with HondaHeavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 assoon as possible.
Check the fluid level in the brakefluid reservoir monthly.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your vehicle’sbraking system and can causeextensive damage.
The brake fluid should be replacedaccording to the time recommenda-tion in the maintenance schedule.
Brake System
Brake Fluid
Maintenance 295
MAX
MIN
Information Provided by:
Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. If it is not available, you mayuse another power steering fluid asan emergency replacement.However, continued use can causeincreased wear and poor steering incold weather. Have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.
Check the level when the engine iscold. Look at the side of thereservoir. The fluid should bebetween the UPPER LEVEL andLOWER LEVEL. If it is below theLOWER LEVEL, add power steeringfluid to the UPPER LEVEL.
A low power steering fluid level canindicate a leak in the system. Checkthe fluid level frequently and havethe system inspected as soon aspossible.
Power Steering
Maintenance296
LOWER LEVEL
UPPER LEVEL
Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.
Information Provided by:
To replace it:
The air cleaner element is inside theair cleaner housing on the driver’sside of the engine compartment.
Disconnect the cable from the aircleaner housing cover by pushingthe plastic clip and pulling on it.Remove the cable from theconnector.
The air cleaner element should bereplaced according to the time anddistance recommendations in themaintenance schedule.
Loosen the four bolts with aPhillips-head screwdriver.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Replacement
Air Cleaner Element
Maintenance 297
CONNECTOR
BOLTSCLIP
Information Provided by:
Remove the old air cleanerelement.
Carefully clean the inside of theair cleaner housing with a damprag.
Place the new air cleaner elementin the air cleaner housing.
Reinstall the air cleaner housingcover. Tighten the four bolts.Reinstall the clip on the cover.Clamp the cable with theconnector.
Clean the hood latch assembly with amild cleaner, then lubricate it with amultipurpose grease. Lubricate allthe moving parts (as shown),including the pivot. Follow the timeand distance recommendations inthe Maintenance Schedule. If youare not sure how to clean and greasethe latch, contact your Honda dealer.
3.
4.
6.
5.
Maintenance
Air Cleaner Element, Hood Latch
Hood Latch
298
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT LATCH ASSEMBLY
Information Provided by:
Loosen the two holding clips byturning the heads one-quarter turncounterclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver. Remove the cover onthe front cylinder bank by pullingit straight up.
Clean off any dirt and oil that havecollected around the ignition coils.
The spark plugs in your vehicle are aspecial platinum-tipped design forlonger life. The spark plugs shouldbe replaced according to the timeand distance recommendations inthe maintenance schedule.
Remove the four bolts using ahexagon socket wrench, thenremove the engine cover.
1.2.
3.
CONTINUED
Replacement
Maintenance
Spark Plugs
299
HOLDING CLIP
Information Provided by:
Disconnect the wire connectorfrom the ignition coil by pushingon the lock tab and pulling on theconnector. Pull on the plasticconnector, not the wires.
Remove the spark plug witha five-eighths inch (16 mm) sparkplug socket.
Use a wrench to remove thehexagon socket head cap boltholding the ignition coil. Removethe ignition coil by pulling itstraight out.
Put the new spark plug into thesocket, then screw it into the hole.Screw it in by hand so you do notcrossthread it.
4. 5.
6.
7.
Maintenance
Spark Plugs
300
HEXAGON SOCKET HEAD CAP BOLT
Information Provided by:
+-
Torque the spark plug. (If you donot have a torque wrench, tightenthe spark plug two-thirds of a turnafter it contacts the cylinder head.)Tightening torque:
Spark Plug Gap:
Install the ignition coil. Reinstallthe hexagon socket head cap bolt.
Push the wire connector onto theignition coil. Make sure it locks inplace.
Repeat this procedure for theother five spark plugs.
Reinstall the cover on the frontcylinder bank while putting itsmounting clip in the hole on thepassenger’s side. Secure the coverby turning the heads of the twoholding clips one-quarter turnclockwise with a flat-tippedscrewdriver.
NGK:DENSO:
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Specifications:
Spark Plugs
Maintenance 301
13 lbf·ft (18 N·m , 1.8 kgf·m)
0.04 in (1.1 mm)
PKJ16CR-L11PZFR5F-11
00.1 mm
Tighten the spark plugs caref ully. Aspark plug that is too loose canoverheat and damage the engine.Overtightening can cause damage tothe threads in the cylinder head.
Information Provided by:
-
If the terminals are severely cor-roded, clean them with baking sodaand water. Then use a wrench toloosen and remove the cables fromthe terminals. Always disconnect thenegative ( ) cable first and recon-nect it last. Clean the battery termi-nals with a terminal cleaning tool orwire brush. Reconnect and tightenthe cables, then coat the terminalswith grease.
Check the battery terminals forcorrosion (a white or yellowishpowder). To remove it, cover theterminals with a solution of bakingsoda and water. It will bubble up andturn brown. When this stops, wash itoff with plain water. Dry off thebattery with a cloth or paper towel.Coat the terminals with grease tohelp prevent future corrosion.
Battery posts,terminals, and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.
Check the condition of your vehicle’sbattery monthly.
Check the battery condition bylooking at the test indicator windowon the battery.The label on the battery explains thetest indicator’s colors.
WARNING:
Wash hands after handling.
Battery
Maintenance302
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
Information Provided by:
If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damage to the vehicle’selectrical system.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, theAUTO function of the driver’swindow will be disabled. You shouldreset the AUTO function (see page
).
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem will disable itself. The nexttime you turn on the radio you willsee ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code (see page
).189
101
On EX model
Battery
Maintenance 303
The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.
A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.
Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledmechanic do the batterymaintenance.
Charging the battery with the cablesconnected can seriously damage yourvehicle’s electronic controls. Detachthe battery cables bef ore connectingthe battery to a charger.
Information Provided by:
Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every six months.Look for signs of cracking in therubber, or areas that are gettinghard. Replace the blades if you findthese signs, or if they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.
To replace a wiper blade:Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm by pushing inthe lock tab. Hold the lock tab inwhile you push the blade assemblytoward the base of the arm.
Raise the wiper arm off thewindow.Windshield: Raise the driver’s sidefirst, then the passenger’s side.
Front only:2.
1.
Wiper Blades
Maintenance304
WIPER ARMS
LOCK TAB
Do not open the hood when the wiperarms are raised, or you will damage thehood and the arms.
Information Provided by:
Slide the new wiper blade into theholder until the tabs lock.
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metal rein-forcement along the back edge,remove the metal reinforcementstrips from the old wiper blade andinstall them in the slots along theedge of the new blade.
Remove the blade from its holderby grasping the tabbed end of theblade. Pull firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.
Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.
Front only:
Lower the wiper arm down againstthe window.Windshield: Lower the passenger’sside first, then the driver’s side.
6.
7.
4.
5.
3.
Wiper Blades
Maintenance 305
BLADE BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
Information Provided by:
Run the air conditioning at least oncea week during the cold weathermonths. Run it for at least tenminutes while you are driving at asteady speed with the engine atnormal operating temperature. Thiscirculates the lubricating oil con-tained in the refrigerant.
If the air conditioning does not get ascold as before, have your dealercheck the system. Recharge thesystem with Refrigerant HFC-134a(R-134a). (See Specifications on page
.)
Your vehicle’s air conditioning is asealed system. Any major mainte-nance, such as recharging, should bedone by a qualified mechanic. Youcan do a couple of things to makesure the air conditioning worksefficiently.
Periodically check the engine’sradiator and air conditioningcondenser for leaves, insects, anddirt stuck to the front surface. Theseblock the air flow and reduce coolingefficiency. Use a light spray from ahose or a soft brush to remove them.
362
Air Conditioning System
Maintenance306
AIR CONDITIONINGCONDENSER
Whenever you have the air conditioningsystem serviced, make sure the servicef acility uses a ref rigerant recyclingsystem. This system captures theref rigerant f or reuse. Releasingref rigerant into the atmosphere candamage the environment.
The condenser and radiator f ins bendeasily. Only use a low-pressure sprayor sof t-bristle brush to clean them.
Information Provided by:
- -
Check the condition of the two drivebelts (power steering belt andalternator belt). Examine the edgesof each belt for cracks or fraying.
If you see signs of wear or looseness,have your dealer adjust or replacethe belts.
Power steering belt:
The belt should have the following‘‘play’’ or deflection.
Check the tension of the powersteering belt by pushing on it withyour thumb midway between thepulleys.
The dust and pollen filter removespollen and dust that is brought infrom the outside through the heatingand cooling system/climate controlsystem.
This filter should be replaced every30,000 miles (48,000 km) undernormal conditions. It should bereplaced every 15,000 miles (24,000km) if you drive primarily in urbanareas that have high concentrationsof soot in the air from industry anddiesel-powered vehicles. Replace itmore often if air flow from theclimate control system becomes lessthan usual. Have the dust and pollenfilter replaced by your Honda dealer.
Drive BeltsDust and Pollen Filter
Maintenance
Dust and Pollen Filter, Drive Belts
307
POWER STEERING BELT
ALTERNATOR BELT
0.51 0.65 in (13.0 16.5 mm)
Information Provided by:
- -
Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life, and ridingcomfort. Underinflated tires wearunevenly, adversely affect handlingand fuel economy, and are morelikely to fail from being overheated.Overinflated tires can make yourvehicle ride more harshly, are moreprone to damage from road hazards,and wear unevenly.
We recommend that you visuallycheck your tires every day. If youthink a tire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
To safely operate your vehicle, yourtires must be the proper type andsize, in good condition with adequatetread, and correctly inflated. Thefollowing pages give more detailedinformation on how and when tocheck air pressure, how to inspectyour tires for damage and wear, andwhat to do when your tires need tobe replaced.
The timing belt should normally bereplaced at the intervals shown inthe maintenance schedule.
Replace the belt at 60,000 miles (U.S.)or 100,000 km (Canada) if you regu-larly drive your vehicle in one ormore of these conditions:
In very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C).In very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C).Frequently tow a trailer.
InflationTiresTiming Belt
Timing Belt, Tires
Maintenance308
Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.
Information Provided by:
The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal driving conditions andspeeds. Tire pressures for highspeed driving are the same as fornormal driving.
The compact spare tire pressure is:
If you check the pressure when thetires are hot (the vehicle has beendriven several miles), you will seereadings 4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3to 0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreading. This is normal. Do not letair out to match the specified coldpressure. The tire will beunderinflated.
You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tire problemand not due to a variation betweengauges.
Use a gauge to measure the airpressure at least once a month. Eventires that are in good condition maylose one to two psi (10 to 20 kPa, 0.1to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per month.Remember to check the spare tire atthe same time you check all theother tires.
Check the pressure in the tires whenthey are cold. This means the vehiclehas been parked for at least threehours. If you have to drive thevehicle before checking the tirepressure, the tires can still beconsidered ‘‘cold’’ if you drive lessthan 1 mile (1.6 km).
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving
CONTINUED
Recommended Tire Pressures forNormal Driving
Tires
Maintenance 309
P235/70R16 104S 32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2kgf/cm )
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle’s tires have wear indica-tors molded into the tread. When thetread wears down to that point, youwill see a 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wideband running across the tread. Thisshows there is less than 1/16 inch(1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. Atire that is this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see thetread wear indicator in three or moreplaces around the tire.
Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.You should look for:
Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.
Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.
Excessive tread wear.
These pressures are also given onthe tire information label on thedriver’s doorjamb.
Tubeless tires have some ability toself-seal if they are punctured.However, because leakage is oftenvery slow, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.
Inspection
Tires
Maintenance310
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Information Provided by:
To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, youshould have the tires rotated every7,500 miles (12,000 km). Move thetires to the positions shown in thechart each time they are rotated.
Make sure the installer balances thewheels when you have new tiresinstalled. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. Your vehicle’soriginal tires were dynamic or ‘‘spin’’balanced at the factory. For bestresults, have the installer perform adynamic balance.
In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.
The tires were properly balanced bythe factory. They may need to berebalanced at some time before theyare worn out. Have your dealercheck the tires if you feel a consis-tent vibration while driving. A tireshould always be rebalanced if it isremoved from the wheel for repair.
CONTINUED
Tire RotationMaintenance
Tires
Maintenance 311
Front Front
(For Non-directionalTires and Wheels)
(For DirectionalTires and Wheels)
Improper wheel weights can damageyour vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Useonly genuine Honda wheel weights f orbalancing.
Information Provided by:
It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, then replace the twofront tires or the two rear tires as apair. Replacing just one tire canseriously affect your vehicle’s han-dling.
When shopping for replacementtires, you may find that some tiresare ‘‘directional.’’ This means theyare designed to rotate only in onedirection. If you use directional tires,they should be rotated only front-to-back.
The tires that came with yourvehicle were selected to match theperformance capabilities of thevehicle while providing the bestcombination of handling, ridecomfort, and long life. You shouldreplace them with radial tires of thesame size, load range, speed rating,and maximum cold tire pressurerating (as shown on the tire’ssidewall). Mixing radial and bias-plytires on your vehicle can reduce itsbraking ability, traction, and steeringaccuracy.
Replacing Tires and Wheels
Tires
Maintenance312
Installing improper tires on yourvehicle can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.
Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.
Information Provided by:
+Tires that are marked ‘‘M S’’ or‘‘All Season’’ on the sidewall have anall-weather tread design. Theyshould be suitable for most winterdriving conditions. Tires withoutthese markings are designed foroptimum traction in dry conditions.They may not provide adequateperformance in winter driving.For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.
The ABS works by comparing thespeed of the wheels. When replacingtires, use the same size originallysupplied with the vehicle. Tire sizeand construction can affect wheelspeed and may cause the system towork inconsistently.
Wheel:
Tire:
See page for information aboutDOT Tire Quality Grading.If you ever need to replace a wheel,
make sure the wheel’s specificationsmatch those of the original wheelthat came on your vehicle. Re-placement wheels are available atyour Honda dealer.
364
CONTINUED
Winter DrivingWheels and Tires
Tires
Maintenance 313
16 x 6 1/2 JJ
P235/70R16 104S
Information Provided by:
When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions andmount them as tightly as you can.Drive slowly with them installed. Ifyou hear them coming in contactwith the body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Make sure the cables areinstalled tightly, and that they arenot contacting the brake lines orsuspension. Remove them as soon as
you begin driving on cleared roads.
Metal link-type ‘‘chains’’ should notbe used. No matter how tight theyseem to be installed, they can comeinto contact with the body andsuspension, causing serious damage.
If you mount snow tires on yourHonda, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels to balanceyour vehicle’s handling in all weatherconditions. Keep in mind the tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay not be as high as your vehicle’soriginal equipment tires. You shoulddrive cautiously even when the roadsare clear. Check with the tire dealerfor maximum speed recommenda-tions.
Because your Honda has limited tireclearance, mount only SAE Class ‘‘S’’cable-type traction devices, withrubber chain tensioners, on the fronttires. Use traction devices only whenrequired by driving conditions orlocal laws. Make sure they are thecorrect size for your tires.
Snow Tires Tire Chains
Tires
Maintenance314
Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.
Information Provided by:
Check the operation of your vehicle’sexterior lights at least once a month.A burned out bulb can create anunsafe condition by reducing yourvehicle’s visibility and the ability tosignal your intentions to otherdrivers.
Lights
Maintenance 315
PARKING LIGHT/SIDE MARKER
TURN SIGNAL/PARKING LIGHT
HEADLIGHT
Information Provided by:
Check the following:
HeadlightsParking lightsTaillightsBrake lightsTurn signalsBack-up lightsHigh-mount brake lightHazard light functionLicense plate lightsSide marker lightsDaytime running lights(Canadian models)
If you find any bulbs are burned out,replace them as soon as possible.Refer to the chart on page todetermine what type of replacementbulb is needed.
363
Lights
Maintenance316
SIDE MARKER LIGHT
LICENSE PLATE LIGHTSBACK-UP LIGHT
TURN SIGNAL/HAZARD LIGHT/TAIL LIGHT
STOP/TAIL LIGHT
HIGH-MOUNT BRAKE LIGHT
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
The headlights were properly aimedwhen your vehicle was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thecargo area or pull a trailer,readjustment may be required.Adjustment of the headlights shouldbe performed by a Honda technicianor other qualified mechanic.
Your vehicle has halogen headlightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its steel base and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
Open the hood.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pulling theconnector straight back.
Remove the rubber weather sealby pulling on the tab.
Unclip the end of the hold-downwire from its slot. Pivot it out ofthe way and remove the bulb.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Replacing a Headlight BulbHeadlight Aiming
Lights
Maintenance 317
CONNECTOR
BULBHalogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.
Information Provided by:
Insert the new bulb into the hole,making sure the bulb is right sideup and the nubs on the base fitinto the indentations in theheadlight assembly. Pivot the hold-down wire back in place, and clipthe end into the slot.
Install the rubber seal over theback of the headlight assembly.Make sure one of its arrows ispointing up.
Push the electrical connector ontothe new bulb.Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
To remove the front turn signalbulb, push it in slightly and turn itcounterclockwise.
Install the new bulb into thesocket.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
5.
6.
7.
Lights
Maintenance
Replacing a Front Turn Signal/Parking Light Bulb
318
Information Provided by:
If you are changing the bulb onthe driver’s side, start the engine,turn the steering wheel all the wayto the right, and turn off theengine. If you are changing thebulb on the passenger’s side, turnthe steering wheel to the left.
Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the five holding clips fromthe inner fender.
Pull the inner fender cover awayfrom the fender and bumper.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the burned out bulb straightout of its socket.Push the new bulb straight intothe socket until it bottoms.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Put the inner fender in place.Install the five holding clips. Lockeach clip in place by pushing onthe center.1.
2.
3.
4.
8.
6.
7.
5.
Lights
Replacing a Front Side MarkerLight Bulb
Maintenance 319
HOLDING CLIP
Information Provided by:
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the two screws, then pullthe rear light assembly straightback to remove it from the body.
Determine which of the threebulbs is burned out: stop/taillight,turn signal/hazard lights, or sidemarker light.
Remove the burned out bulb bypulling it straight out of its socket.
Install the new bulb into thesocket.
Push the socket into the lightassembly and turn it clockwiseuntil it locks.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Make sure all the wires arecorrectly routed on the rear lightassembly, then install theassembly on the body.
Open the tailgate.1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Lights
Maintenance
Replacing Rear Bulbs
320
Information Provided by:
Remove the lens by carefullyprying on its left edge with a flat-tip screwdriver.
Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out. Push a new bulb intothe socket.
Reinstall the lens, left side first.
Open the tailgate. Place a cloth onthe edge of back-up light cover.Remove it by carefully prying inthe notch on its edge with a smallflat-tipped screwdriver.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push a new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Insert the socket back into thelight assembly. Turn it clockwiseto lock it in place.
Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.
Reinstall the back-up light cover.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
CONTINUED
Replacing a Rear License PlateBulb
Replacing a Back-up light bulb
Lights
Maintenance 321
Information Provided by:
The individual map lights, tailgatelight, and the vanity mirror lightscome apart the same way. They donot all use the same bulb.
Remove the lens by carefullyprying on the edge of the lens witha fingernail file or a small flat-tipscrewdriver. Do not pry on theedge of the housing around thelens.
Pull the light assembly out of thetailgate.
Remove the socket from the lightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push a new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Place a cloth on the middle edgeof a part of the lens on thepassenger’s side. Remove a part ofthe lens by carefully prying on itsedge with a small flat-tippedscrewdriver.
Use a Phillips-head screwdriver toremove the screw under the lens.
1.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Lights
Maintenance
Replacing Bulbs in the InteriorLights
Replacing a High-mount BrakeLight Bulb
322
FRONT INDIVIDUAL MAP LIGHT
SCREW
Information Provided by:
Front individual map light:Pry on the front edge in front of bothmap lights.
Rear individual map light:Pry on the rear edge of the lens inthe middle.
Tailgate light:Pry on the upper edge to the left andright of center.
Remove the bulb by pulling itstraight out of its metal tabs.
Push the new bulb into the metaltabs. Snap the lens back in place.
2.
3.
Lights
Maintenance 323
DOOR LIGHTTAILGATE LIGHT
SUN VISOR LIGHTGRAB RAIL LIGHT
Information Provided by:
If you need to park your vehicle foran extended period (more than onemonth), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your vehicle back on the road. Ifpossible, store your vehicle indoors.
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.
Leave one window open slightly (ifthe vehicle is being storedindoors).Fill the fuel tank.
Change the engine oil and filter(see page ).
Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.
Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc. arecompletely dry.
Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.
Support the front and rear wiperblade arms with a folded towel orrag so they do not touch thewindshield.
Disconnect the battery.
To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand tailgate seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand tailgate seals.
Cover the vehicle with a‘‘breathable’’ cover, one madefrom a porous material such ascotton. Nonporous materials, suchas plastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.
If possible, run the engine for awhile periodically (preferably oncea month).
If you store your vehicle for 12months or longer, have your Hondadealer perform the inspections calledfor in the 24 months/30,000 miles(48,000 km) maintenance schedule(Normal Conditions) as soon as youtake it out of storage (see page ).The replacements called for in themaintenance schedule are notneeded unless the vehicle hasactually reached that time or mileage.
285
274
Storing Your Vehicle
Maintenance324
Information Provided by:
Regular cleaning and polishing ofyour Honda helps to keep it ‘‘new’’looking. This section gives youinformation on how to clean yourvehicle and preserve its appearance:the paint, brightwork, wheels andinterior. Also included are severalthings you can do to help preventcorrosion.
.................................Exterior Care . 326.....................................Washing . 326
.......................................Waxing . 327....................Aluminum Wheels . 327
..........................Paint Touch-up . 327..................................Interior Care . 328...................................Carpeting . 328.................................Floor Mats . 328
.........................................Fabric . 329...........................................Vinyl . 329
.......................................Leather . 329...................................Seat Belts . 329....................................Windows . 330
..........................Air Fresheners . 330....................Corrosion Protection . 331
.................................Body Repairs . 332
Appearance Care
Appearance Care 325
Information Provided by:
Frequent washing helps preserveyour vehicle’s beauty. Dirt and gritcan scratch the paint, while tree sapand bird droppings can permanentlyruin the finish.
Wash your vehicle in a shady area,not in direct sunlight. If the vehicle isparked in the sun, move it into theshade and let the exterior cool downbefore you start.
When you have washed and rinsedthe whole exterior, dry it with achamois or soft towel. Letting itair-dry will cause dulling and waterspots.
Rinse the vehicle thoroughly withcool water to remove loose dirt.
Only use the solvents and cleanersrecommended in this Owner’sManual.
Fill a bucket with cool water. Mixin a mild detergent, such asdishwashing liquid or a productmade especially for car washing.
Wash the vehicle using the waterand detergent solution and a soft-bristle brush, sponge, or soft cloth.Start at the top and work your waydown. Rinse frequently.
Check the body for road tar, treesap, etc. Remove these stains withtar remover or turpentine. Rinse itoff immediately so it does notharm the finish. Remember to re-wax these areas, even if the rest ofthe vehicle does not need waxing.
As you dry the vehicle, inspect it forchips and scratches that could allowcorrosion to start. Repair them withtouch-up paint (see page ).327
Exterior Care
Appearance Care
Washing
326
Chemical solvents and strong cleanerscan damage the paint, metal, andplastic on your vehicle.
The radio antenna on your vehicle doesnot need to be removed when you use a‘‘drive-through’’ car wash. However, ifyou remove the antenna, make sure toreinstall it and tighten it securely usingan appropriate tool.
Information Provided by:
-
-
Your dealer has touch-up paint tomatch your vehicle’s color. The colorcode is printed on a sticker on thedriver’s doorjamb. Take this code toyour dealer so you are sure to getthe correct color.
Inspect your vehicle frequently forchips or scratches in the paint.Repair them right away to preventcorrosion of the metal underneath.Use the touch-up paint only on smallchips and scratches. More extensivepaint damage should be repaired bya professional.
Always wash and dry the wholevehicle before waxing it. You shouldwax your vehicle, including the metaltrim, whenever water sits on thesurface in large patches. It shouldform into beads or droplets afterwaxing.
Cleaning tar, insects, etc. withremovers also takes off the wax.Remember to re-wax those areas,even if the rest of the vehicle doesnot need waxing.You should use a quality liquid or
paste wax. Apply it according to theinstructions on the container. Ingeneral, there are two types ofproducts:
The wheels have a protective clear-coat that keeps the aluminum fromcorroding and tarnishing. Usingharsh chemicals, including somecommercial wheel cleaners, or stiffbrushes can damage this clear-coat.Only use a mild detergent and softbrush or sponge to clean the wheels.
Waxes A wax coats the finish andprotects it from damage by exposureto sunlight, air pollution, etc. Youshould use a wax on your Hondawhen it is new.
Polishes Polishes and cleaner/waxes can restore the shine to paintthat has oxidized and lost some of itsshine. They normally contain mildabrasives and solvents that remove
the top layer of the finish. Youshould use a polish on your Honda ifthe finish does not have its originalshine after using a wax.
Clean your Honda’s aluminum alloywheels as you do the rest of theexterior. Wash them with the samesolution, and rinse them thoroughly.
Exterior Care
Appearance Care
Paint Touch-upWaxing
Aluminum Wheels
327
Information Provided by:
Vacuum the carpeting frequently toremove dirt. Ground-in dirt will makethe carpet wear out faster.Periodically shampoo the carpet tokeep it looking new. Use one of thefoam-type carpet cleaners on themarket. Follow the instructions thatcome with the cleaner, applying itwith a sponge or soft brush. Keepthe carpeting as dry as possible bynot adding water to the foam.
Do not put additional floor mats ontop of the anchored mat, otherwisethe additional mats may slideforward and interfere with the pedals.
The Genuine Honda driver’s floormat that came with your vehicle wasdesigned to be hooked over the floormat anchor. This keeps the floor matfrom sliding forward and possiblyinterfering with the pedals.
If you remove the driver’s floor mat,make sure to re-anchor it when youput it back in your vehicle.
If you replace it, use a genuineHonda floor mat that is designed tobe used with the floor mat anchor inyour vehicle.
If you use a non-Honda floor mat inthe driver’s footwell, make sure itfits properly and that it can be usedwith the floor mat anchor.
Carpeting Floor Mats
Appearance Care
Interior Care
328
Information Provided by:
Remove dirt and dust with a vacuumcleaner. Wipe the vinyl with a softcloth dampened in a solution of mildsoap and water. Use the samesolution with a soft-bristle brush onmore difficult spots. You can also usecommercially-available spray orfoam-type vinyl cleaners.
If your seat belts get dirty, you canuse a soft brush with a mixture ofmild soap and warm water to cleanthem. Do not use bleach, dye, orcleaning solvents. They can weakenthe belt material. Let the belts air-dry before you use the vehicle.
Vacuum dirt and dust out of thematerial frequently. For generalcleaning, use a solution of mild soapand lukewarm water, letting it air dry.To clean off stubborn spots, use acommercially-available fabric cleaner.Test it on a hidden area of the fabricfirst, to make sure it does not bleachor stain the fabric. Follow theinstructions that come with thecleaner. Vacuum dirt and dust from the
leather frequently. Pay particularattention to the pleats and seams.Clean the leather with a soft clothdampened with clear water, thenbuff it with a clean, dry cloth. Iffurther cleaning is needed, use asoap specifically for leather, such assaddle soap. Apply this soap with adamp, soft cloth. Wipe down andbuff as described above.
CONTINUED
Vinyl Seat BeltsFabric
Leather
Interior Care
Appearance Care 329
LOOP
Information Provided by:
Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.
Clean the windows, inside and out,with a commercially-available glasscleaner. You can also use a mixtureof one part white vinegar to ten partswater. This will remove the haze thatbuilds up on the inside of thewindows. Use a soft cloth or papertowels to clean all glass and clearplastic surfaces.
If you want to use an air freshener/deodorizer in the interior of yourvehicle, it is best to use a solid type.Some liquid air fresheners containchemicals that may cause parts ofthe interior trim and fabric to crackor discolor.
If you use a liquid air freshener,make sure you fasten it securely so itdoes not spill as you drive.
Windows Air Fresheners
Interior Care
Appearance Care330
The rear window defogger wires arebonded to the inside of the glass.Wiping vigorously up-and-down candislodge and break the def ogger wires.When cleaning the rear window, usegentle pressure and wipe side-to-side.
Information Provided by:
Two factors normally contribute tocausing corrosion in your vehicle:
Moisture trapped in body cavities.Dirt and road salt that collects inhollows on the underside of thevehicle stays damp, promotingcorrosion in that area.
Removal of paint and protectivecoatings from the exterior andunderside of the vehicle.
Repair chips and scratches in thepaint as soon as you discover them.
Inspect and clean out the drainholes in the bottom of the doorsand body.
Check the floor coverings fordampness. Carpeting and floormats may remain damp for a longtime, especially in winter. Thisdampness can eventually causethe floor panels to corrode.
Use a high-pressure spray to cleanthe underside of your vehicle. Thisis especially important in areasthat use road salt in winter. It isalso a good idea in humid climatesand areas subject to salt air. Becareful of the ABS wheel sensorsand wiring at each wheel.
Have the corrosion-preventivecoatings on the underside of yourvehicle inspected and repairedperiodically.
Many corrosion-preventive measuresare built into your Honda. You canhelp keep your vehicle fromcorroding by performing somesimple periodic maintenance:
1.
2.
Corrosion Protection
Appearance Care 331
Information Provided by:
Body repairs can affect your vehicle’sresistance to corrosion. If yourvehicle needs repairs after a collision,pay close attention to the parts usedin the repair and the quality of thework.
Make sure the repair facility usesgenuine Honda replacement bodyparts. Some companies make sheetmetal pieces that seem to duplicatethe original Honda body parts, butare actually inferior in fit, finish, andcorrosion resistance. Once installed,they do not give the same high-quality appearance.
When reporting your collision to theinsurance company, tell them youwant genuine Honda parts used inthe repair. Although most insurersrecognize the quality of originalparts, some may try to specify thatthe repairs be done with otheravailable parts. You should investi-gate this before any repairs havebegun.
Take your vehicle to your authorizedHonda dealer for inspection after therepairs are completed. Your dealercan make sure that quality materialswere used, and that corrosion-preventive coatings were applied toall repaired and replaced parts.
Body Repairs
Appearance Care332
Information Provided by:
This section covers the more-common problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your vehicle towed.
......................Compact Spare Tire . 334....................Changing a Flat Tire . 335
..........If Your Engine Won’t Start . 342Nothing Happens or the
Starter Motor Operates........................Very Slowly . 342
The Starter Operates................................Normally . 342................................Jump Starting . 343
............If Your Engine Overheats . 345.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 347..........Charging System Indicator . 348
.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 349...............Brake System Indicator . 351
..............................................Fuses . 352..........Checking and Replacing . 353
......................Emergency Towing . 358
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Taking Care of the Unexpected 333
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle has a compact sparetire that takes up less space. Use thisspare tire as a temporary replace-ment only. Get your regular tirerepaired or replaced and put it backon your vehicle as soon as you can.
The compact spare tire has a shortertread life than a regular tire. Replaceit when you can see the tread wearindicator bars. The replacementshould be the same size and designtire, mounted on the same wheel.The compact spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the compact wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.
Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:
This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some road sur-faces than the regular tire. Usegreater caution while driving onthis tire.
Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)under any circumstances.
Follow these precautions wheneveryou are using the compact spare tire:
Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare.
Do not use the compact spare tireif you are towing a trailer.
The wheel of the compact sparetire is designed especially to fityour vehicle. Do not use yourspare tire on another vehicleunless it is the same make andmodel.
Compact Spare Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected334
INDICATOR LOCATION MARK
TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Information Provided by:
If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Stopping in traffic or on the shoulderof a busy road is dangerous. Driveslowly along the shoulder until youget to an exit or an area to stop thatis far away from the traffic lanes.
Turn on the hazard warning lights,and turn the ignition switch toLOCK (0). Have all thepassengers get out of the vehiclewhile you change the tire.
Park the vehicle on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground away fromtraffic. Put the transmission inPark. Apply the parking brake.
2.1.
CONTINUED
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected 335
JACK
SPARE TIRETOOLS
The vehicle can easily roll offthe jack, seriously injuringanyone underneath.
Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the vehiclewhen it is supported only by thejack.
Information Provided by:
Open the tailgate. Take the tools out of the storagecompartment.
Turn the jack’s end bracketcounterclockwise to loosen it, thenremove the jack.
The tools and jack are behind acover in the cargo area on thedriver’s side. Remove the cover bypushing the top of the cover.
The spare tire is storedunderneath the rear cargo area.Remove the plastic cover on thecargo area lining to access theshaft for the spare tire hoist.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected336
COVER COVER
Information Provided by:
Loosen the five wheel nuts 1/2turn with the wheel wrench.
Put the wheel nut wrench on thehoist shaft. Turn the wrenchcounterclockwise to lower thespare tire to the ground.
Keep turning the wheel wrench tocreate slack in the cable.
Remove the bracket from thespare tire.
11.
10.
8. 9.
CONTINUED
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected 337
SPARE TIRE WRENCH BRACKET
Information Provided by:
△
Use the extension and wheelwrench as shown to raise thevehicle until the flat tire is off theground.
Remove the wheel nuts, thenremove the flat tire. Temporarilyplace the flat tire on the groundwith the outside surface of thewheel facing up. You could scratchthe wheel if you put it face down.
Locate the jacking point nearestthe tire you need to change. It ispointed to by a mark moldedinto the underside of the body.Place the jack under the jackingpoint. Turn the end bracketclockwise until the top of the jackcontacts the jacking point. Makesure the jacking point tab isresting in the jack notch.
12. 13. 14.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected338
JACKING POINT WHEEL WRENCH
EXTENSION
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully, it may be hot fromdriving.
Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tightenthem fully.
Lower the vehicle to the groundand remove the jack.
15. 16. 17.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected 339
BRAKE HUB
Information Provided by:
Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:
Remove the center cap from theflat tire.
Place the flat tire face up underthe hoist.
Slowly turn the wheel wrenchclockwise to take up the slack ofthe hoist cable. Make sure thebracket is seated in the centerhole of the spare tire.
Turn the wheel wrench clockwiseuntil the flat tire rests against theunderbody of the vehicle and youhear the hoist click.
Insert the hoist bracket into thecenter hole of the flat tire.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected340
80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)
Information Provided by:
Store the jack in its holder. Turnthe jack’s end bracket to lock it inplace. Store the tools, and installthe cover.
24.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking Care of the Unexpected 341
Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.
Always raise the spare tire hoist, evenif you are not stowing a tire. If thehoist is lef t down, it will be damagedduring driving and need to be replaced.
Information Provided by:
Diagnosing why your engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn thekey to START (III):
You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.
You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.
When you turn the ignition switch toSTART (III), you do not hear thenormal noise of the engine trying tostart. You may hear a clicking soundor series of clicks, or nothing at all.Check these things:
Check the transmission interlock.The transmission must be in Parkor Neutral or the starter will notoperate.
Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).Turn on the headlights and checktheir brightness. If the headlightsare very dim or don’t light at all,the battery is discharged. See
on page .
Turn the ignition switch to START(III). If the headlights do not dim,check the condition of the fuses. Ifthe fuses are OK, there is proba-bly something wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. (See
on page .)
If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery is dis-charged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition ofthe battery and terminal connec-tions (see page ). You canthen try jump starting the vehiclefrom a booster battery (see page
).
In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to START (III), butthe engine does not run.
Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to
on page .
343
358
302
343
232
Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly
Jump Starting
Emergency Towing
The Starter Operates Normally
Starting theEngine
Taking Care of the Unexpected
If Your Engine Won’t Start
342
Information Provided by:
To jump start your vehicle, followthese directions closely:If your vehicle’s battery has run
down, you may be able to start theengine by using a booster battery.Although this seems like a simpleprocedure, you should take severalprecautions.
Put the transmission in Neutral orPark, and set the parking brake.
Open the hood and check thephysical condition of the battery(see page ). In very coldweather, check the condition ofthe electrolyte. If it seems slushyor like ice, do not try jump startinguntil it thaws.
Turn off all the electrical acces-sories: heater, A/C, climatecontrol, stereo system, lights, etc.
Your vehicle has the ImmobilizerSystem. You should use aproperly-coded master or valet keyto start the engine (see page ).A key that is not properly codedwill cause the immobilizer systemindicator in the dash panel to blinkrapidly.
Do you have fuel? Turn theignition switch to ON (II) for aminute and watch the fuel gauge.The low fuel level warning lightmay not be working, so you werenot reminded to fill the tank.
There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).
If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See
on page .
You cannot start your Honda bypushing or pulling it.
1.
2.
80
356
358
302
CONTINUED
Jump Starting
EmergencyTowing
If Your Engine Won’t Start, Jump Starting
Taking Care of the Unexpected 343
A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.
Information Provided by:
-
+
+
Start your vehicle. If the startermotor still operates slowly, checkthe jumper cable connections tomake sure they have good metal-to-metal contact.
Once your vehicle is running,disconnect the negative cable fromyour vehicle, then from thebooster battery. Disconnect thepositive cable from your vehicle,then the booster battery.
Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding strapas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.
The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables.
If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourHonda’s battery. Connect theother end to the positive ( )terminal on the booster battery. 5.
7.
3.
4.
6.
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Jump Starting
344
BOOSTER BATTERY
Information Provided by:
If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine.
If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading(climbing a long, steep hill on ahot day with the A/C running, forexample), the engine should startto cool down almost immediately.If it does, wait until the tempera-ture gauge comes down to the mid-point then continue driving.
Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Neutral orPark and set the parking brake.Turn off the heating and cooling/climate control system and allother accessories. Turn on thehazard warning indicators.
Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until all aredisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.
The pointer of your vehicle’stemperature gauge should stay inthe midrange under most conditions.It may go higher if you are driving upa long steep hill on a very hot day. Ifit climbs to the red mark, you shoulddetermine the reason.
Your vehicle can overheat for severalreasons, such as lack of coolant or amechanical problem. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to or above the redmark. Or you may see steam orspray coming from under the hood.In either case, you should takeimmediate action.
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Jump Starting, If Your Engine Overheats
If Your Engine Overheats
345
Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.Driving with the temperature gauge
pointer at the red mark can causeserious damage to your engine.
Information Provided by:
If the temperature gauge stays atthe red mark, turn off the engine.
Wait until you see no more signsof steam or spray, then open thehood.
If you don’t find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank (see page
). If the level is below theMIN mark, add coolant to halfwaybetween the MIN and MAX marks.
If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may also have toadd coolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the pointer
reaches the middle of the tempera-ture gauge, or lower, before check-ing the radiator.
Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. Thisreleases any remaining pressure inthe cooling system. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap and turn it until it comesoff.
Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see
on page ).
Start the engine and set thetemperature control dial tomaximum (climate control toFULL AUTO at 90°F/32°C). Addcoolant to the radiator up to thebase of the filler neck. If you donot have the proper coolantmixture available, you can addplain water. Remember to havethe cooling system drained andrefilled with the proper mixture assoon as you can.
If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.
Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine and watchthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the red mark, the engineneeds repair. (See
on page .)
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
358
221 358
Taking Care of the Unexpected
If Your Engine Overheats
EmergencyTowing
EmergencyTowing
346
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
Information Provided by:
This indicator should light when theignition switch is ON (II), and go outafter the engine starts. It shouldnever come on when the engine isrunning. If it starts flashing, itindicates that the oil pressuredropped very low for a moment, thenrecovered. If the indicator stays onwith the engine running, it showsthat the engine has lost oil pressureand serious engine damage ispossible. In either case, you shouldtake immediate action.
Safely pull off the road and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning indicators.
If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).
Let the vehicle sit for a minute.Open the hood and check the oillevel (see page ). Although oillevel and oil pressure are notdirectly connected, an engine thatis very low on oil can lose pressureduring cornering and other drivingmaneuvers.
Start the engine and watch the oilpressure indicator. If the lightdoes not go out within ten seconds,turn off the engine. There is amechanical problem that needs tobe repaired before you cancontinue driving. (See
on page .)1.
2.
3.
4.
220
283
358
Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Taking Care of the Unexpected
EmergencyTowing
347
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR
Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe vehicle stopped.
Information Provided by:
This indicator should come on whenthe ignition switch is ON (II), and goout after the engine starts. If itcomes on brightly when the engineis running, it indicates that thecharging system has stoppedcharging the battery.
By eliminating as much of theelectrical load as possible, you candrive several miles (kilometers)before the battery is too dischargedto keep the engine running. Drive toa service station or garage whereyou can get technical assistance.
Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories: radio, heater, A/C,climate control, rear defogger, cruisecontrol, etc. Try not to use otherelectrically-operated controls such asthe power windows. Keep the enginerunning and take extra care not tostall it. Starting the engine willdischarge the battery rapidly.
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Charging System Indicator
348
CHARGING SYSTEM INDICATOR
Information Provided by:
If the indicator remains on past threedriving trips, or the fuel cap was notloose or missing, have the vehiclechecked by the dealer as soon aspossible. Drive moderately until thedealer has inspected the problem.Avoid full-throttle acceleration anddriving at high speed.
You should also have the dealerinspect your vehicle if this indicatorcomes on repeatedly, even though itmay turn off as you continue driving.
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch ON (II), andgoes off after the engine starts. If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates one of the engine’semissions control systems may havea problem. Even though you mayfeel no difference in your vehicle’sperformance, it can reduce your fueleconomy and cause your vehicle toput out excessive emissions.Continued operation may causeserious damage.
If you have recently refueled yourvehicle, the cause of this indicatorcoming on could be a loose ormissing fuel fill cap. Check the capand tighten it until it clicks severaltimes. Replace the fuel fill cap if it ismissing. Tightening the cap will notmake the indicator turn offimmediately; it takes at least threedriving trips. This indicator may also come on
along with the ‘‘D’’ indicator.
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Taking Care of the Unexpected 349
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP
If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols and engine. Those repairs maynot be covered by your vehicle’swarranties.
Information Provided by:
If possible, do not take your vehiclefor a state emissions test until thereadiness codes are set. To check ifthey are set, turn the ignition ON (II),but do not start the engine. TheMalfunction Indicator Lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks 5 times, the readinesscodes are not set. Refer to StateEmissions Testing for moreinformation.(See page .)
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.
If your vehicle’s battery has beendisconnected or gone dead, thesecodes are erased. It takes severaldays of driving under variousconditions to set the codes again.
371
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Readiness Codes
350
Information Provided by:
However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. Because of thebrake system’s dual-circuit design, aproblem in one part of the systemwill still give you braking at twowheels. You will feel the brake pedalgo down much farther before thevehicle begins to slow down, and youwill have to press harder on thepedal. The distance needed to stopwill be much longer.
If it comes on at any other time, itindicates a problem with the vehicle’sbrake system. In most cases, theproblem is a low fluid level in thebrake fluid reservoir. Press lightly onthe brake pedal to see if it feelsnormal. If it does, check the brakefluid level the next time you stop at aservice station (see page ). If thefluid level is low, take the vehicle toyour dealer and have the brakesystem inspected for leaks or wornbrake pads.
Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of thelonger distance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the vehicle. Youshould have it towed, and repaired assoon as possible. (See
on page .)
If you must drive the vehicle a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and cautiously.
The Brake System Indicator comeson when you turn the ignition ON(II). If the parking brake is not set, itgoes off after you start the engine. Ifthe parking brake is set, it goes offwhen you fully release the parkingbrake with the engine running.
295358
EmergencyTowing
Brake System Indicator
Taking Care of the Unexpected 351
BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR
U. S. indicator shown
Information Provided by:
All the electrical circuits in yourvehicle have fuses to protect themfrom a short circuit or overload.These fuses are located in three fuseboxes.
The interior fuse boxes are locatedunderneath the dashboard on eachside.
To open the fuse box on thepassenger’s side, pull the right edgeof the cover.
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected352
DRIVER’S SIDE INTERIOR PASSENGER’S SIDE INTERIOR
Information Provided by:
If something electrical in yourvehicle stops working, the first thingyou should check for is a blown fuse.Determine from the chart on pages
and , or the diagram on thefuse box lid (the diagram for thedriver’s side interior fuse box is onthe kick panel below the fuse box),which fuse or fuses control thatcomponent. Check those fuses first,but check all the fuses beforedeciding that a blown fuse is not thecause. Replace any blown fuses andcheck the component’s operation.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK(0). Make sure the headlights andall other accessories are off.
Remove the cover from the fusebox.
The secondary fuse box is in theengine compartment next to thebattery.
The primary under-hood fuse box islocated on the passenger’s side ofthe engine compartment. To open it,push the tabs as shown. 1.
2.
356 357
CONTINUED
Checking and Replacing Fuses
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected 353
UNDER-HOOD UNDER-HOOD
Information Provided by:
Look for a burned wire inside thefuse. If it is burned, replace it withone of the spare fuses of the samerating or lower.
Check each of the large fuses inthe primary under-hood fuse boxby looking through the top at thewire inside. Removing these fusesrequires a Phillips-head screw-driver.
Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse box and all thefuses in the interior fuse boxes bypulling out each fuse with the fusepuller provided in the primaryunder-hood fuse box.
5.4.3.
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected354
BLOWN FUSE PULLER
BLOWN
Information Provided by:
If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem in your vehicle.Leave the blown fuse in thatcircuit and have your vehiclechecked by a qualified mechanic.
If you cannot drive the vehiclewithout fixing the problem, and youdo not have a spare fuse, take a fuseof the same rating or a lower ratingfrom one of the other circuits. Makesure you can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).
If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.
If the radio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the radio youwill see ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the Preset buttons toenter the five-digit code (see page
).
6.
189
CONTINUED
On EX model
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected 355
Replacing a fuse with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have a replace-ment f use with the proper rating f or thecircuit, install one with a lower rating.
Information Provided by:
-
-
No.
No. Amps. Circuits Protected
No.Amps. Circuits Protected Amps. Circuits Protected
123456789
10111213
1234
40 A20 A20 A20 A
ABS MotorABS F/SRear ACC Socket4WD
1415161718192021222324
20 A30 A20 A15 A15 A
20 A20 A20 A40 A40 A30 A40 A
Spare FuseSpare FuseRight HeadlightACG SHazardNot usedStopLeft HeadlightRadioPower Window MotorPower SeatRear DefrosterBack Up, ACC
30 A40 A30 A
7.5 A10 A15 A
120 A30 A
7.5 A50 A
Rear A/CHeater MotorCooling FanSpare FuseSpare FuseSpare FuseBatteryCondenser FanMG ClutchIGI MainNot used
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected356
PRIMARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
SECONDARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
Information Provided by:
*
**
-
--*
*
Amps.No. Circuits ProtectedNo. Amps.Circuits Protected
15 A10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A7.5 A15 A
7.5 A7.5 A10 A
7.5 A15 A30 A
7.5 A
123
456789
10111213
On Canadian models
Driver’s Power WindowDriver’s Power Seat RecliningHeated SeatDriver’s Power Seat SlidingNot usedDaytime Running LightDriver’s side Rear PowerWindowFront Passenger’s PowerWindowFront Accessory Socket, RadioSmall LightInterior Light, NaviPower Door LockBack UpNot usedNot usedPassenger’s Side Rear PowerWindow
1234567
8
910111213141516
20 A20 A20 A20 A
10 A20 A
20 A
15 A15 A10 A20 A
7.5 A
20 A
Fuel PumpSRSHeater Control, A/C ClutchRelay, Cooling Fan RelayPower Mirror, VTM-4Daytime Running LightECU (PCM), Cruise ControlOPDS, Rear WiperACC RelayBack-up Lights, InstrumentLightsTurn SignalsIG CoilFront WiperStarter Signal
1 : Canadian models
1
Fuses
Taking Care of the Unexpected 357
Driver’s Side
INTERIOR FUSE BOX
Passenger’s Side
FrontFront
:
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
If your vehicle needs to be towed,call a professional towing service or,if you belong to one, an organizationthat provides roadside assistance.Never tow your vehicle behindanother vehicle with just a rope orchain. It is very dangerous.
There are three popular types ofprofessional towing equipment.
The operatorloads your vehicle on the back of atruck.
Any othermethod of towing will damage thedrive system. When you contact thetowing agency, inform them that aflat-bed is required.
The towtruck uses two pivoting arms that gounder the tires (front or rear) and liftthem off the ground. The other twotires remain on the ground.
Refer toon page
for non-emergency towinginformation.
The towtruck uses metal cables with hookson the ends. These hooks go aroundparts of the frame or suspension andcables lift that end of the vehicle offthe ground. Your vehicle’ssuspension and body can beseriously damaged.
259
Flat-bed Equipment
Wheel Lift Equipment
Sling-type Equipment
This is the only way totransport your vehicle.
Never tow your vehicle withwheel lif t equipment.
Towing Your VehicleBehind a Motorhome
This method oftowing your Pilot is unacceptable.
Emergency Towing
Taking Care of the Unexpected358
Towing a Pilot with only two tires onthe ground will damage parts of the4WD system. It should be transportedon a f lat-bed truck or trailer.
Information Provided by:
The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour Honda, and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.
................Identification Numbers . 360................................Specifications . 362
..........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 364Uniform Tire Quality
..................................Grading . 364.................................Treadwear . 364
......................................Traction . 364.............................Temperature . 365
.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 366......Driving in Foreign Countries . 367
.......................Emissions Controls . 368.....................The Clean Air Act . 368
Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 368
Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 368
Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 368
...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 369....................PGM-FI System . 369
Ignition Timing Control................................System . 369
Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 369
Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 369
....................Replacement Parts . 369..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 370
..............State Emissions Testing . 371....Testing of Readiness Codes . 371
Technical Information
Technical Information 359
Information Provided by:
Your vehicle has several identifyingnumbers located in various places.
The Vehicle Identification Number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourHonda dealer uses to register yourvehicle for warranty purposes. It isalso necessary for licensing andinsuring your vehicle. The easiestplace to find the VIN is on a platefastened to the top of the dashboard.You can see it by looking throughthe windshield on the driver’s side. Itis also on the Certification label at-tached to the driver’s doorjamb, andis stamped on the engine com-partment bulkhead. The VIN is alsoprovided in bar code on theCertification label.
Identif ication Numbers
Technical Information360
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
CERTIFICATION LABEL
Information Provided by:
The Transmission Number is on alabel on top of the transmission.
The Engine Number is stamped intothe engine block. It is on the front.
Identif ication Numbers
Technical Information 361
ENGINE NUMBER
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER
Information Provided by:
*
*
*
*
- - *
*
*
*
Specifications
Technical Information362
CapacitiesDimensions
Weights
Air Conditioning
Fuel tank
EnginecoolantEngine oil
AutomatictransmissionfluidReardifferentialfluidWindshieldwasherreservoir
1.74 US gal (6.6 , 1.45 Imp gal)2.25 US gal (8.5 , 1.87 Imp gal)
5.1 US qt (4.8 , 4.2 Imp qt)
4.5 US qt (4.3 , 3.8 Imp qt)
5.8 US qt (5.5 , 4.8 Imp qt)3.2 US qt (3.0 , 2.6 Imp qt)8.2 US qt (7.8 , 6.9 Imp qt)
Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengine.Reserve tank capacity:0.16 US gal (0.6 , 0.13 Imp gal)Excluding the oil remaining in the engine.
19.3 US gal (73 , 16.1 Imp gal)
2.79 US qt (2.64 , 2.32 Imp qt)
188.0 in (4,775 mm)76.3 in (1,938 mm)70.6 in (1,793 mm)
4.8 US qt (4.5 , 4.0 Imp qt)
66.3 in (1,685 mm)66.5 in (1,690 mm)
LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack
Gross vehicle weight rating
Gross combined weightrating (GCWR)
See the tire information label atta-ched to the driver’s doorjamb.
9,700 lbs (4,400 kg)
Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant type
HFC-134a (R-134a)24.7 26.5 oz (700 750 g)
ND-OIL8
106.3 in (2,700 mm)
Approx.
FrontRear
1 :
2 :
Equipped with transmission fluid cooler and power steering fluidcooler.
ChangeTotalChange
IncludingfilterWithoutfilter
TotalChangeTotal
Change
The GCWR must be reduced 2 percent for every 1,000 feet (305meters) of elevation.
1 :
2 :
2
1
2
1
Information Provided by:
--
---
------------
-
Specifications
Technical Information 363
Tires
Alignment
Engine
FusesLights
Battery
60 W/55 W12 V
Size
Pressure60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
T155/90D16 110MP235/70R16 104S
Toe-in
Camber
Caster 1°88’0°50’0°50’
0.00 in (0.0 mm)0.00 in (0.0 mm)
Type
Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratioSpark plugs
10.0 : 1211.8 cu-in (3,471 cm )
3.50 x 3.66 in (89.0 x 93.0 mm)
Interior
Under-hood12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V
Water cooled 4-stroke SOHC,V6 gasoline engine
HeadlightsFront side marker lightsFront turn signal lights/Parking lightsRear side marker lightsRear turn signal/hazard lightsStop/TaillightsBackup lightsLicense plate lightsHigh-mount brake lightIndividual map lightsTailgate lightVanity mirror lightDoor (Courtesy) lightGrabrail lightsConsole lights
12 V12 V
12 V
5 W27 W/8 W
5 W21 W/5 W21 W/5 W21 CP (18 W)5 W18 W6.2 W5 W1.1 W3.8 W
Capacity 12 V 65 AH/20 HR
14 V12 V 12.4 W
1.4 W
See page 357 or the fuse labelattached to the dashboard.See page 357 or the fuse labelattached to the inside of the fusebox door under the dashboard.See page 356 or the fuse boxcover.
See spark plug maintenancesection page 301 .
Front/RearSpareFront/RearSpare
FrontRearFrontRearFront
Driver’s side
Passenger’s side(1157 NA)
(168)(7443)(7443)(921)(168)(921)(204)
(HB2)(168)
Information Provided by:
-The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.
The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.
The tires on your vehicle meet allU.S. Federal Safety Requirements.All tires are also graded fortreadwear, traction, and temperatureperformance according toDepartment of Transportation(DOT) standards. The followingexplains these gradings.
Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween the tread shoulder and themaximum section width. Forexample:
All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.
Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
Technical Information
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Treadwear
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Traction AA, A, B, C
Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A
364
Information Provided by:
-The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and not over-loaded. Excessive speed, underinfla-tion, or excessive loading, eitherseparately or in combination, cancause heat buildup and possible tirefailure.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Technical Information
Temperature A, B, C
365
Information Provided by:
Some conventional gasolines arebeing blended with alcohol or anether compound. These gasolinesare collectively referred to asoxygenated fuels. To meet clean airstandards, some areas of the UnitedStates and Canada use oxygenatedfuels to help reduce emissions.
If you use an oxygenated fuel, besure it is unleaded and meets theminimum octane rating requirement.
Before using an oxygenated fuel, tryto confirm the fuel’s contents. Somestates/provinces require thisinformation to be posted on thepump.
The following are the U.S. EPA andCanadian CGSB approvedpercentages of oxygenates:
(Methyl Tertiary ButylEther)You may use gasoline containing upto 15 percent MTBE by volume.
(ethyl or grain alcohol)You may use gasoline containing upto 10 percent ethanol by volume.Gasoline containing ethanol may bemarketed under the name ‘‘Gasohol.’’
(methyl or woodalcohol)Your vehicle was not designed to usefuel that contains methanol.Methanol can corrode metal parts inthe fuel system, and also damageplastic and rubber components. Thisdamage would not be covered byyour warranties.
If you notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.
Fuel system damage or performanceproblems resulting from the use ofan oxygenated fuel containing morethan the percentages of oxygenatesgiven above are not covered underwarranty.MTBE
ETHANOL
METHANOL
Technical Information
Oxygenated Fuels
366
Information Provided by:
If you are planning to take yourHonda outside the U.S. or Canada,contact the tourist bureaus in theareas you will be traveling in to findout about the availability of unleadedgasoline with the proper octanerating.
If unleaded gasoline is not available,be aware that using leaded gasolinein your Honda will affect perfor-mance and fuel mileage, and damageits emissions controls. It will nolonger comply with U.S. andCanadian emissions regulations, andwill be illegal to operate in NorthAmerica. To bring your vehicle backinto compliance will require the re-placement of several components,such as the oxygen sensors and thethree way catalytic converter. Thesereplacements are not covered underwarranty.
Technical Information
Driving in Foreign Countries
367
Information Provided by:
*
*The burning of gasoline in yourvehicle’s engine produces several by-products. Some of these are carbonmonoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen(NOx) and hydrocarbons (HC).Gasoline evaporating from the tankalso produces hydrocarbons. Con-trolling the production of NOx, CO,and HC is important to the environ-ment. Under certain conditions ofsunlight and climate, NOx and HCreact to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’Carbon monoxide does not contri-bute to smog creation, but it is apoisonous gas.
In Canada, Honda vehicles complywith the Canadian emissionrequirements, as specified in anagreement with EnvironmentCanada, at the time they aremanufactured.
Your vehicle has a PositiveCrankcase Ventilation System. Thiskeeps gasses that build up in theengine’s crankcase from going intothe atmosphere. The Positive Crank-
case Ventilation valve routes themfrom the crankcase back to theintake manifold. They are thendrawn into the engine and burned.
As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.
The Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.
The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.Scheduled maintenance is on page
.272
The Clean Air Act
Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem
Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem
Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery
Technical Information
Emissions Controls
368
Information Provided by:
The exhaust emissions controlsinclude four systems: PGM-FI,Ignition Timing Control, ExhaustGas Recirculation and Three WayCatalytic Converter. These foursystems work together to control theengine’s combustion and minimizethe amount of HC, CO, and NOx thatcomes out the tailpipe. The exhaustemissions control systems areseparate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.
The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your vehicle. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.The PGM-FI System uses sequential
multiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: Air Intake,Engine Control, and Fuel Control.The Powertrain Control Module(PCM) uses various sensors todetermine how much air is goinginto the engine. It then controls howmuch fuel to inject under all operat-ing conditions.
This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO and NOx produced.
The Exhaust Gas Recirculation(EGR) system takes some of theexhaust gas and routes it back intothe intake manifold. Adding exhaustgas to the air/fuel mixture reducesthe amount of NOx produced whenthe fuel is burned.
The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), dinitrogen(N ), and water vapor.
The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to work to-gether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newgenuine Honda replacement parts ortheir equivalent for repairs. Usinglower quality parts may increase theemissions from your vehicle.
2
2
Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement Parts
PGM-FI System
Ignition Timing Control System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Technical Information
Emissions Controls
369
Information Provided by:
A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your vehicle’s three waycatalytic converter.
Keep the engine tuned-up.
Have your vehicle diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.
Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.
The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire any com-bustible materials that come near it.Park your vehicle away from highgrass, dry leaves, or other flamma-bles.
The three way catalytic convertercontains precious metals that serveas catalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converter is referred toas a three-way catalyst, since it actson HC, CO, and NOx. A replacementunit must be an original Honda partor its equivalent.
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Technical Information370
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
Information Provided by:
Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 8hours or more.
Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 20° and95°F.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Keep the vehicle in Park.Increase the engine speed to 2,000rpm and hold it there until thetemperature gauge rises to at least1/4 of the scale (approximately 3minutes).
If you take your vehicle for a stateemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.
If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle re-tested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for re-testingby doing the following.
Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20minutes. Drive on the highway inD. Do not use the cruise control.When traffic allows, drive for 90seconds without moving theaccelerator pedal. (Vehicle speedmay vary slightly; this is okay.) Ifyou cannot do this for acontinuous 90 seconds because oftraffic conditions, drive for at least30 seconds, then repeat it twomore times (for a total of 90seconds).
Technical Information
Testing of Readiness Codes
State Emissions Testing
371
Information Provided by:
Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.
If the testing facility determinesthe readiness codes are still notset, see your Honda dealer.
State Emissions Testing
Technical Information372
Information Provided by:
Customer Relations................................Information . 374
....................Warranty Coverages . 375Reporting Safety Defects
..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 376.....................Authorized Manuals . 377
Warranty and Customer Relations
Warranty and Customer Relations 373
Information Provided by:
U.S. Owners:
Canadian Owners:
Honda dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. TheService Manager or GeneralManager can help. Almost allproblems are solved in this way.
If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact your HondaCustomer Relations Office.
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. VirginIslands:
Vehicle Identification Number(see page )Name and address of the dealerwho services your vehicleDate of purchaseMileage on your vehicleYour name, address, and tele-phone numberA detailed description of theproblemName of the dealer who sold thevehicle to you
When you call or write, please giveus this information:
360
Customer Relations Information
Warranty and Customer Relations374
CUSTOMER RELATIONS
RELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÉLE
American Honda Motor Co.Honda Consumer Affairs DepartmentMail Stop 500-2N-7D1919 Torrance BoulevardTorrance, California 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009
Honda Canada Inc.715 Milner AvenueToronto, ONM1B 2K8
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909
Toronto (416) 287-4776
Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816
San Juan, Puerto Rico 00919-0816
(787) 250-4318
Information Provided by:
-
--
-
-
- -
-
-
a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered for the useful life of thevehicle.
providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns thevehicle.
all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.
coversyour new vehicle, except for thebattery, emissions control systems,and accessories, against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
these twowarranties cover your vehicle’s emis-sions control systems. Time, mileage,and coverage are conditional. Pleaseread the warranty manual for exactinformation.
this warranty gives upto 100 percent credit toward areplacement battery.
Your new Honda is covered by thesewarranties:
covers all genuineHonda replacement parts againstdefects in materials and workman-ship.
provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from a Honda dealer.
Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2003 Honda Warranty Informationbooklet that came with your vehiclefor precise information on warrantycoverages. Your Honda’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.
Please refer to the 2003 WarrantyManual that came with your vehicle.
Honda Accessories are coveredunder this warranty. Time andmileage limits depend on the type ofaccessory and other factors. Pleaseread your warranty manual fordetails.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty
Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty
Rust Perforation Limited WarrantyNew Car Limited Warranty
Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty
Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty
Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty
Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty
Accessory Limited Warranty
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
Warranty Coverages
Warranty and Customer Relations 375
Information Provided by:
To contact NHTSA, you may eithercall the Auto Safety Hotline toll-freeat 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 inWashington D.C. area) or write to:NHTSA, U.S. Department ofTransportation, Washington,D.C. 20590. You can also obtainother information about motorvehicle safety from the Hotline.
If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA) in additionto notifying American Honda MotorCo., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)
Warranty and Customer Relations376
Information Provided by:
-
*
*
*
*2003
HON
Valid only for sales within the U.S. Canadian owners shouldcontact their authorized Honda dealer.
The publications shown below can be purchased from HelmIncorporated. You can order in any of three ways:
Detach and mail the order form on the right half of this pageCall Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356Go online at
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc. at1-800-782-4356
(credit card orders only)
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals(U.S. only)
Authorized Manuals
377
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356
OR
(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)
MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00
Publication
Form Number
61S9V00
61S9V00EL
61S9V30
31S9V600
31S9V700
31S9VQ00
HON-R
Form Description
2003 Honda Pilot
Service Manual
2003 Honda Pilot
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2003 Honda Pilot
Body Repair Manual
2003 Honda Pilot
Owner’s Manual
2003 Honda Pilot
Navigation System Owner’s Manual
2003 Honda Pilot
Quick Start Guide
Order Form for Previous Years-
Indicate Year and Model Desired
Price
Each
$70.00
$50.00
$44.00
$34.00
$29.00
$10.00
FREE
PUBLICATION NUMBERVEHICLE MODEL
Name YearQty
Price
Each
Total
Price
GRAND TOTAL
HANDLING CHARGE
Mich. Purchases
Add 6% Sales Tax
TOTAL MATERIAL
$6.00
Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. 6:00 P.M. EST
By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You canpay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail toHelm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.
Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurring obligation.
Orders are mailed within 10 days. Pleaseallow adequate time for delivery.
Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation.
www. helminc. com
Information Provided by:
-
-
-
SHIP
TO
PAYMENT
This manual complements the Service Manual byproviding in-depth troubleshooting information for eachelectrical circuit in your vehicle.
This manual describes the procedures involved in thereplacement of damaged body parts.
This manual covers maintenance and recommendedprocedures for repair to engine and chassis components.It is written for the Journeyman mechanic, but is simpleenough for most mechanically-inclined owners to under-stand.
Service Manual:
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Body Repair Manual:
Authorized Manuals
378
NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name,and also the name of the person to whose attention the shipment shouldbe sent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shownbelow for a quotation.
P.O. BOX 07280·DETROIT, MICHIGAN 48207·1-800-782-4356
Customer Name Attention
Apartment Number
State & Zip CodeCity
Daytime Telephone Number
Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc U.S. funds only.Do not send cash
MasterCard
VISA Check here if your billing address is differentfrom the shipping address shown above.
Account Number Expiration: Mo. Yr.
CUSTOMER SIGNATURE DATE
Street Address No P.O. Box Number
( )
These Publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
...Accessories and Modifications . 223................................Accessories . 223
...Additional Safety Precaution . 224............................Modifications . 224
ACCESSORY (Ignition Key.......................................Position) . 82
............Accessory Power Sockets . 110....................Additives, Engine Oil . 284
...............................Airbag (SRS) . 9, 50.....................Air Cleaner Element . 297
......Air Conditioning System . 118, 130..............................Maintenance . 306
.....................Rear A/C Control . 135.................................Usage . 118, 130
...............Air Outlets (Vents) . 120, 128
.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 308
.......................Alcohol in Gasoline . 366.......Aluminum Wheels, Cleaning . 327
......................................Antifreeze . 287Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
....................Indicator Light . 63, 243...................................Operation . 242
..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 153.Anti-theft Steering Column Lock . 81
..........................Appearance Care . 325................Audio System . 137, 153, 168
...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 48
...Automatic Lighting Off Feature . 73.............Automatic Speed Control . 207..............Automatic Transmission . 233
..........................Capacity, Fluid . 362...............Checking Fluid Level . 293
.......................................Shifting . 234.Shift Lever Position Indicator . 233
................Shift Lever Positions . 234....................Shift Lock Release . 236
BatteryCharging System
...........................Indicator . 62, 348............................Jump Starting . 343
..............................Maintenance . 302............................Specifications . 363
..............................Before Driving . 215....................................Belts, Seat . 8, 46
.........................Beverage Holders . 105.................................Body Repairs . 332
Brakes...........Anti-lock System (ABS) . 242
.............Break-in, New Linings . 216...........................................Fluid . 295
....................Bulb Replacement . 320.......................................Parking . 104
.................System Indicator . 63, 351........................Wear Indicators . 241
.............................Braking System . 241.................Break-in, New Vehicle . 216
..Brightness Control, Instruments . 73........................Brights, Headlights . 72
Bulb Replacement..........................Back-up Lights . 321
..............................Brake Lights . 320......................Cargo Area Light . 323
................Front Parking Lights . 318........Front Side Marker Lights . 319
.................................Headlights . 317..............Individual Map Lights . 322
...................License Plate Light . 321.................................Rear Bulbs . 320
............................Specifications . 363............Turn Signal Lights . 318, 320
..............................Bulbs, Halogen . 317
Index
A
B
I
Information Provided by:
*
................................Cancel Button . 209............................Capacities Chart . 362
.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56.............................Carrying Cargo . 225
Cassette Player............................................Care . 181
...................Operation . 149, 160, 178..............CAUTION, Explanation of . ii
..................CD Changer . 145, 165, 184......................CD Player . 143, 163, 182
........................Certification Label . 360............................................Chains . 315
Change Oil........................................How to . 285
.............................When to . 274, 276....................Changing a Flat Tire . 335
............Changing Engine Coolant . 289...Charging System Indicator . 62, 348
............Checklist, Before Driving . 231..................Childproof Door Locks . 87
.....................................Child Safety . 21.......................................Child Seats . 21
..........Tether Anchorage Points . 42....................Cleaner Element, Air . 297
Cleaning....................Aluminum Wheels . 327
...................................Carpeting . 328......................................Exterior . 326
.........................................Fabric . 329.......................................Interior . 328.......................................Leather . 329
...................................Seat Belts . 329...........................................Vinyl . 329
....................................Windows . 330...............Climate Control System . 128
......................................Coat Hook . 111.....................Code, Audio System . 189
........................CO in the Exhaust . 368........................................Coin Box . 111
............Cold Weather, Starting in . 232..............................Compact Spare . 334
...............Consumer Information . 374.............Controls, Instruments and . 59
Coolant........................................Adding . 287
....................................Checking . 221.........................Proper Solution . 287
...................................Replacing . 289...................Temperature Gauge . 68
....................Corrosion Protection . 331
Crankcase Emissions Control........................................System . 368
............Cruise Control Operation . 207Customer Relations
................................Information . 374
................DANGER, Explanation of . ii...................................Dashboard . 2, 60
................Daytime Running Lights . 73............Defects, Reporting Safety . 376
................Defogger, Rear Window . 77
......Defrosting the Windows . 125, 133....................................Dimensions . 362
...............Dimming the Headlights . 72Dipstick
..........Automatic Transmission . 293..................................Engine Oil . 220
..........................Directional Signals . 74........Disc Brake Wear Indicators . 241
.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 286Doors
..............Locking and Unlocking . 82....................Lockout Prevention . 83
......................Power Door Locks . 82
Index
C
D
II
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
..........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 364.....................................Drive Belts . 307
...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 5...........................................Driving . 229
....................................Economy . 222.........................In Bad Weather . 245
................In Foreign Countries . 367..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 307
...................................DVD Player . 190
..............................Economy, Fuel . 222............Emergencies on the Road . 333.............Battery, Jump Starting . 343...........Brake System Indicator . 351
................Changing a Flat Tire . 335.....Charging System Indicator . 348
..................Checking the Fuses . 353.....Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 347...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 349
..................Overheated Engine . 345.........................Emergency Brake . 104
......................Emergency Flashers . 76......................Emergency Towing . 358.......................Emissions Controls . 368
Engine....Coolant Temperature Gauge . 68
.................................Drive Belts . 307Malfunction Indicator
................................Lamp . 62, 349........Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 347..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 283
...............................Overheating . 345............................Specifications . 363............................Speed Limiter . 236
.......................................Starting . 232......................Ethanol in Gasoline . 366
.Evaporative Emissions Controls . 368...............................Exhaust Fumes . 56
Exhaust Gas Recirculation........................................System . 369
Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat........................................Belts by . 19
..................Exterior, Cleaning the . 326
............................Fabric, Cleaning . 329..........................Fan, Interior . 118, 131
Features, Comfort and..............................Convenience . 117
....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 217Filters
...............................................Air . 297.......................Air Conditioning . 306
...............................................Oil . 285.............Flashers, Hazard Warning . 76
...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 335Fluids
..........Automatic Transmission . 293..........................................Brake . 295
..........................Power Steering . 296..................Windshield Washer . 292
FM Stereo Radio...................................Reception . 176
...................Folding the Third Seat . 95.....Foreign Countries, Driving in . 367
..........................Four-way Flashers . 76.................................................Fuel . 216
......................Fill Door and Cap . 217...........................................Gauge . 68
................Octane Requirement . 216...............................Oxygenated . 366
........................Reserve Indicator . 65........................Tank, Filling the . 217
.....................Fuses, Checking the . 353
Index
E
F
III
Information Provided by:
...............Gas Mileage, Improving . 222..........................................Gasohol . 366.........................................Gasoline . 216
...............Fuel Reserve Indicator . 65...........................................Gauge . 68
................Octane Requirement . 216........................Tank, Filling the . 217
................Gas Station Procedures . 217Gauges
...Engine Coolant Temperature . 68...............................................Fuel . 68
...............................Speedometer . 67.................................Tachometer . 67
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight.......................................Rating) . 248
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight.......................................Rating) . 248
............Gearshift Lever Positions . 234..............................Glass Cleaning . 330
........................................Glove Box . 88GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight
.......................................Rating) . 248
.............Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 317..............Hazard Warning Flashers . 76
........................................Headlights . 72........................................Aiming . 317
..............Automatic Lighting Off . 73............Daytime Running Lights . 73
..................High Beam Indicator . 65...........High Beams, Turning on . 72............Low Beams, Turning on . 72
.........................Reminder Chime . 72........Replacing Halogen Bulbs . 317
...................................Turning on . 72..............................Head Restraints . 93
...............................Heated Mirror . 104.....................Heating and Cooling . 118
.............High Altitude, Starting at . 232.................High-Low Beam Switch . 72
HomeLink Universal...............................Transmitter . 210
....................................Hood Latch . 298.......................Hood, Opening the . 218
..................................................Horn . 71.................................Hydroplaning . 246
...Identification Number, Vehicle . 360Ignition
..............................................Keys . 79...........................................Switch . 81
............Timing Control System . 369........................Immobilizer System . 80
.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.........Indicators, Instrument Panel . 61
..................Individual Map Lights . 114.........................Infant Restraint . 26, 30
................................Infant Seats . 26, 30...................Inflation, Proper Tire . 308
.................................Inside Mirror . 102.............................Inspection, Tire . 310
........................Instrument Panel . 2, 60........Instrument Panel Brightness . 73
...........................Interior Cleaning . 328...............................Interior Lights . 112
........................................Introduction . i
.................Jacking up the Vehicle . 338.......................................Jack, Tire . 335
Index
G H I
J
IV
Information Provided by:
CONTINUED
..................................................Keys . 79
..................................Maintenance . 269...Owner Maintenance Checks . 281
.................................Record . 279-280......................Required Indicator . 69
..........................................Safety . 270.............................Schedule . 274-276
.Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 62, 349..............Manual Seat Adjustments . 91
...............................Meters, Gauges . 67...................Methanol in Gasoline . 366
........................Mirrors, Adjusting . 103
...................Neutral Gear Position . 235..................New Vehicle Break-in . 216
...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i...............Numbers, Identification . 360
..............................Paint Touch-up . 327..............Panel Brightness Control . 73
........................Park Gear Position . 234
................................Jump Starting . 343
.......................Label, Certification . 360.................Lane Change, Signaling . 74
..................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 15, 46....................Light Control Switch . 112
.............................................Lights . 315....................Bulb Replacement . 317
.......................................Indicator . 61.......................................Interior . 112.........................................Parking . 72
..................................Turn Signal . 74....................................Load Limits . 226
......LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 81Locks
.......Anti-theft Steering Column . 81............................Fuel Fill Door . 217
....................................Glove Box . 88....................Lockout Prevention . 83
.................................Power Door . 82
........................Low Coolant Level . 221.........................Low Fuel Indicator . 65
...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 347...Lubricant Specifications Chart . 362
.........................................Luggage . 225
...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 216.........................................Odometer . 67
...............................Odometer, Trip . 67Oil
........................Change, How to . 285..............Change, When to . 274, 276......................Checking Engine . 220..............Pressure Indicator . 62, 347
Selecting Proper Viscosity......................................Chart . 284
...........ON (Ignition Key Position) . 82..Operation in Foreign Countries . 367
............................Outside Mirrors . 102....................Overheating, Engine . 345
.......Owner Maintenance Checks . 281.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 366
Index
L
K
N
M
O
P
V
Information Provided by:
*
...........................................Parking . 240...............................Parking Brake . 104.................................Parking Lights . 72
..Parking Over Things that Burn . 370.............................PGM-FI System . 369
..................Polishing and Waxing . 327................Power Seat Adjustments . 89
............Pre-Drive Safety Checklist . 11.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 19
............................Protecting Adults . 12...Additional Safety Precautions . 19
.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19........................Protecting Children . 21.......................Protecting Infants . 30
.......Protecting Larger Children . 38.........Protecting Small Children . 35
Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 42
.............................Using LATCH . 44
..................................Safety Belts . 8, 46.........Safety Defects, Reporting . 376
.................................Safety Features . 7..........................................Air bags . 9
..................................Door Locks . 10..........................Head Restraints . 10
.......................................Seat Belts . 8.....................Seats & Seat-Backs . 10
.............Safety Labels, Location of . 57...............................Safety Messages . ii
.....................................Seat Belts . 8, 46...............Additional Information . 46
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 48
.....................................Cleaning . 329......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 46
................................Maintenance . 49Reminder Light and
................................Beeper . 46, 62...................System Components . 46
...............Use During Pregnancy . 19...Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 15
...................Radiator Overheating . 345Radio/CD Sound
.......................System . 137, 153, 168...............................Rear A/C Unit . 135
........Rear Entertainment System . 190..Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement . 320
..........................Rear View Mirror . 102.................Rear Window Defogger . 77
.Rear Window Wiper and Washer . 76.........Reclining the Seat Backs . 90, 91
...........Reclining the Second Seats . 92................Reclining the Third Seat . 92
.............................Reminder Lights . 61................Remote Audio Controls . 188
.......................Remote Transmitter . 84Replacement Information
.................Air Cleaner Element . 297.......................................Coolant . 289
................Engine Oil and Filter . 285..........................................Fuses . 353
................................Light Bulbs . 317............................Schedule . 274, 276
................................Spark Plugs . 299
................................Timing Belt . 308...........................................Tires . 312
.............................Wiper Blades . 304Replacing Seat Belts After a
............................................Crash . 49...Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant . 221
..................Reverse Gear Position . 235
................................Rotation, Tire . 311
Index
S
R
VI
Information Provided by:
*
CONTINUED
.....................................Tachometer . 67......Taillights, Changing Bulbs in . 320
.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 333...................Tape Player . 149, 160, 178
Technical Descriptions......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 364.....Emissions Control Systems . 368
.....................Oxygenated Fuels . 366Three Way Catalytic
...............................Converter . 370.......................Temperature Gauge . 68
...................Tensioners, Seat Belts . 48........Testing of Readiness Codes . 371
............................Theft Protection . 189..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 370
....................................Timing Belt . 308
.................................................Seats . 89............Folding the Second Seat . 94
...............Folding the Third Seat . 95..........................Head Restraints . 93
.........Reclining the Second Seat . 92............Reclining the Third Seat . 92
........................Rear Seat Access . 94...............................Serial Number . 360
...........................Service Intervals . 272
...........................Service Manual . 377.........Service Station Procedures . 217
Shifting the Automatic.............................Transmission . 234
.....Shift Lever Position Indicator . 233........................Shift Lock Release . 236
Side Marker Lights, Bulb.........................Replacement in . 319
...............................Signaling Turns . 74.....................................Snow Tires . 314
...................Solvent-type Cleaners . 326................Sound System . 137, 153, 168
Spare Tire......................................Inflating . 334
............................Specifications . 363....................................Spark Plugs . 301
....................Specifications Charts . 362
................................Speed Control . 207...................................Speedometer . 67
..........SRS, Additional Information . 50...Additional Safety Precautions . 55..How the SRS Indicator Works . 53
How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 50
...How Your Side Airbags Work . 52........................SRS Components . 50
..................................SRS Service . 55.............................SRS Indicator . 53, 62
....START (Ignition Key Position) . 82.......................Starting the Engine . 232
In Cold Weather at High..................................Altitude . 232
................With a Dead Battery . 343..............State Emissions Testing . 371
........Steam Coming from Engine . 345Steering Wheel
..................................Adjustment . 78.............Anti-theft Column Lock . 81
...Stereo Sound System . 137, 153, 168....................Storing Your Vehicle . 324
........................Sunglasses Holder . 108........................................Sun Visor . 109
Supplemental Restraint System......................................Servicing . 55
.........................SRS Indicator . 53, 62...................System Components . 50
..................................Synthetic Oil . 284
Index
T
VII
Information Provided by:
*
....................................Tire Chains . 314.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 335
...............................................Tires . 308..............................Air Pressure . 308
...................................Balancing . 311.........................Checking Wear . 310..........................Compact Spare . 334
......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 364......................................Inflation . 308
..................................Inspection . 310...................................Replacing . 312
......................................Rotating . 311...........................................Snow . 314
............................Specifications . 363................................Tire Chains . 314
Towing.....................................A Trailer . 247
................Emergency Wrecker . 358Your Vehicle Behind a
............................Motorhome . 259Transmission
...............Checking Fluid Level . 293...........................Fluid Selection . 293
..............Identification Number . 360.............Shifting the Automatic . 233
.....................................Treadwear . 364
.......................................Trip Meter . 68....................................Turn Signals . 74
...................Tools, Tire Changing . 335
.....................Underside, Cleaning . 331Unexpected, Taking Care
..........................................of the . 333....Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 364
........................Unleaded Gasoline . 216.....................Upholstery Cleaning . 328
.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 286
................................Vanity Mirror . 109.................Vehicle Capacity Load . 226
......................Vehicle Dimensions . 362....Vehicle Identification Number . 360
.............................Vehicle Storage . 324.....................................Ventilation . 123
.................................................VIN . 360...............................Vinyl Cleaning . 329
..................................Viscosity, Oil . 284
..................................VTM-4 Lock . 238
.............WARNING, Explanation of . ii.........Warning Labels, Location of . 57
..................Warranty Coverages . 375Washer, Windshield
........Checking the Fluid Level . 292............................Level Indicator . 65
.....................................Operation . 76.........................................Washing . 326
..................Waxing and Polishing . 327Wheels
...............Adjusting the Steering . 78............Alignment and Balance . 311
..........................Compact Spare . 334......................................Wrench . 337
Windows.....................................Cleaning . 330
..................Operating the Power . 99...........................Rear, Defogger . 77
Windshield.....................................Cleaning . 330...........................Defroster . 125, 133
.......................................Washers . 76Wipers, Windshield
.......................Changing Blades . 304
Index
V
W
U
VIII
Information Provided by:
*
.....................................Operation . 74Rear Windshield Wiper and
.....................................Washer . 76....................................Worn Tires . 310
.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 358
: U.S. and Canada only
Index
IX
Information Provided by:
Service Information Summary
Gasoline: Tire Pressure (measured cold):Power Steering Fluid:
Brake Fluid:
Rear Differential Fluid:
Fuel Tank Capacity:
Recommended Engine Oil:
Automatic Transmission Fluid:
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Honda Power Steering Fluidpreferred, or another brand ofpower steering fluid as atemporary replacement. Do notuse ATF (see page ).
Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).
Front/Rear:
Compact Spare Tire:
Honda VTM-4 Differential Fluid(see page ).
Unleaded gasoline, pump octanenumber of 86 or higher.
API Service SJ ‘‘EnergyConserving’’ oil, SAE 5W-20viscosity (see page ).
Oil change capacity (includingfilter):
5.1 US qt (4.8 , 4.2 Imp qt)
Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid) preferred, ora DEXRON III ATF as atemporary replacement (see page
).
296
295
294
283
293
19.3 US gal (73 , 16.1 Imp gal)
Information Provided by: